blob: 8305515d905fcbf69b6b64b47810ce074bedc539 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucfe14662017-11-19 09:55:29 +01007 2017/11/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200561 - thread-map
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100562 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100563 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100564 - 51degrees-data-file
565 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200566 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200567 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100568 - wurfl-data-file
569 - wurfl-information-list
570 - wurfl-information-list-separator
571 - wurfl-engine-mode
572 - wurfl-cache-size
573 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200576 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200578 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100579 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100580 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100581 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200582 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200583 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200584 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - noepoll
587 - nokqueue
588 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100589 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300590 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000591 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200592 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200593 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200594 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000595 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000596 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200597 - tune.buffers.limit
598 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200600 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100601 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200602 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200603 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200604 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100605 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200606 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200607 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100608 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100609 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100610 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100611 - tune.lua.session-timeout
612 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200613 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100614 - tune.maxaccept
615 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200616 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200617 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200618 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100619 - tune.rcvbuf.client
620 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100621 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100622 - tune.sndbuf.client
623 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100624 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100625 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200626 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100627 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200628 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200629 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100630 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200631 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100632 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200633 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
634 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
635 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100636 - tune.zlib.memlevel
637 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100638
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 * Debugging
640 - debug
641 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006443.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645------------------------------------
646
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200647ca-base <dir>
648 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200649 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
650 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652chroot <jail dir>
653 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
654 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
655 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
656 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
657 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
658 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100659
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100660cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num[-process_num]> <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100661 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
662 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
663 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100664 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
665 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100666 are ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited
667 by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
668 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
669 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
670 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
671 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
672 or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all
673 of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each
674 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100675
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200676crt-base <dir>
677 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
678 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
679 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200681daemon
682 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
683 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100684 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
685 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200686
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200687deviceatlas-json-file <path>
688 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
689 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
690
691deviceatlas-log-level <value>
692 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
693 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
694
695deviceatlas-separator <char>
696 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
697 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
698
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100699deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200700 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
701 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
702 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100703
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900704external-check
705 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
706 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
707 See "option external-check".
708
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709gid <number>
710 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
711 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
712 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100713 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
714 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100716
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100717hard-stop-after <time>
718 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
719
720 Arguments :
721 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
722 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
723 SIGUSR1 signal.
724
725 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
726 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
727 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
728
729 Example:
730 global
731 hard-stop-after 30s
732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733group <group name>
734 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
735 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200737log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
739 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100740 configured with "log global".
741
742 <address> can be one of:
743
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100744 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
746 port).
747
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100748 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
749 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
750 port).
751
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100752 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
753 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
754 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
755 writeable).
756
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200757 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
758 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100759
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200760 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
761 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
762 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
763 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
764 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
765 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
766 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
767 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
768 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
769 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200770 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
771 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200772
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200773 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
774 one of the following :
775
776 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
777 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
778
779 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
780 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
781
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100782 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783
784 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
785 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
786 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
787
788 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200789 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
790 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
791 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
792 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
793 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
794 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200796 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200797
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100798log-send-hostname [<string>]
799 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
800 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
801 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
802 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
803 the logs.
804
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000805log-tag <string>
806 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
807 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
808 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100809 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000810
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100811lua-load <file>
812 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
813 used multiple times.
814
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200815master-worker [exit-on-failure]
816 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
817 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
818 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
819 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
820 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
821 systemd.
822 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
823 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
824 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
825 the whole process.
826
827 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200829nbproc <number>
830 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
831 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
832 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
833 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
834 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
835
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200836nbthread <number>
837 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
838 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
839 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
840 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
841 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
842
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200843pidfile <pidfile>
844 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
845 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
846 starting the process. See also "daemon".
847
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100848presetenv <name> <value>
849 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
850 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
851 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
852 and "unsetenv".
853
854resetenv [<name> ...]
855 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
856 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
857 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
858 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
859 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
860 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
861 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
862 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
863
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100864stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200865 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
866 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
867 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
868 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
869 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
870 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100871 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200872 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
873 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200874
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200875server-state-base <directory>
876 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200877 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
878 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200879
880server-state-file <file>
881 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
882 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
883 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
884 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
885 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
886 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
887 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
888 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200889 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
890 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200891
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100892setenv <name> <value>
893 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
894 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
895 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
896 and "unsetenv".
897
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100898ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
900 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300901 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100902 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
903 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
904 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
905 "bind" keyword for more information.
906
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100907ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
909 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
910 keyword to see available options.
911
912 Example:
913 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200914 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100915
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100916ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
918 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300919 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100920 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
921 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
922 information.
923
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100924ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
926 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
927 keyword to see available options.
928
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200929ssl-dh-param-file <file>
930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
931 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
932 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
933 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
934 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200935 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
936 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
937 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
938 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200939 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
940 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
941 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
942
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100943ssl-server-verify [none|required]
944 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
945 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
946 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
947
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200948
949thread-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <"all"|"odd"|"even"|thread_num> <cpu-set>...
950 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
951 binds a thread to a specific CPU set. The process must be specified to allow
952 different mapping for different processes. For details about the arguments,
953 see "cpu-map" directive. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its
954 mapping and the one of the process on which it is attached. If the
955 intersection is null, no specific bind will be set for the thread.
956
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200957stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
958 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
959 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
960 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200961 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200962 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200963
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200964 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
965 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
966 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200967
968stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
969 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
970 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100971 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200972
973stats maxconn <connections>
974 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
975 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
976
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977uid <number>
978 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
979 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
980 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
981 one. See also "gid" and "user".
982
983ulimit-n <number>
984 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
985 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
986 option.
987
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100988unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
989 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
990
991 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
992 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
993 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
994 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
995 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
996 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
997 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
998 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
999 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1000 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1001
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001002unsetenv [<name> ...]
1003 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1004 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1005 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1006 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1007 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1008 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1009 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1010
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001011user <user name>
1012 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1013 See also "uid" and "group".
1014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001015node <name>
1016 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1017
1018 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1019 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1020 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1021 traffic.
1022
1023description <text>
1024 Add a text that describes the instance.
1025
1026 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1027 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1028 "<" and ">" characters.
1029
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100103051degrees-data-file <file path>
1031 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1032 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1033
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001034 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001035 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1036
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000103751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001038 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1039 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1040 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1041
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001043 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1044
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200104551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001046 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1047 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1048
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001049 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1050 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1051
105251degrees-cache-size <number>
1053 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1054 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1055 By default, this cache is disabled.
1056
1057 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001058 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1059
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001060wurfl-data-file <file path>
1061 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1062 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1063
1064 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1065 with USE_WURFL=1.
1066
1067wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1068 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1069 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1070 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1071
1072 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1073
1074 Valid WURFL properties are:
1075 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1076
1077 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1078 device.
1079
1080 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1081 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1082
1083 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1084 particular web request.
1085
1086 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1087 used Libwurfl API version.
1088
1089 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1090 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1091 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1092
1093 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1094 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1095
1096 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1097 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1098
1099 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1100
1101 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1102
1103 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1104 with USE_WURFL=1.
1105
1106wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1107 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1108 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1109
1110 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1111 with USE_WURFL=1.
1112
1113wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1114 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1115 thus before the chroot.
1116
1117 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1118 with USE_WURFL=1.
1119
1120wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1121 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1122 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1123 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1124 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1125 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1126 mode is enabled by default.
1127
1128 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1129 with USE_WURFL=1.
1130
1131wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1132 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1133 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1134 - "0" : no cache is used.
1135 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1136 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1137 the highest performing option.
1138
1139 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1140 with USE_WURFL=1.
1141
1142wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1143 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1144 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1145
1146 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1147 with USE_WURFL=1.
1148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011503.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151-----------------------
1152
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001153max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1154 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1155 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1156 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1157 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1158 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1159 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1160 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1161 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163maxconn <number>
1164 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1165 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1166 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001167 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1168 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1169 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1170 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001171 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1172 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1173 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1174 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1175 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001177maxconnrate <number>
1178 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1179 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1180 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1181 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1182 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1183 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1184 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1185 fairness.
1186
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001187maxcomprate <number>
1188 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001189 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001190 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1191 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1192 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1193 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1194 default value.
1195
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001196maxcompcpuusage <number>
1197 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1198 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1199 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1200 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1201 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1202 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1203 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1204 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1205
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001206maxpipes <number>
1207 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1208 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1209 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1210 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1211 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1212 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1213
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001214maxsessrate <number>
1215 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1216 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1217 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1218 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1219 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1220 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1221 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1222 fairness.
1223
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001224maxsslconn <number>
1225 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1226 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1227 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1228 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1229 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1230 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1231 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001232 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1233 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1234 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1235 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1236 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1237 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1238 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001239
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001240maxsslrate <number>
1241 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1242 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1243 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1244 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1245 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1246 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1247 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1248 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1249 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1250 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1251
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001252maxzlibmem <number>
1253 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1254 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1255 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001256 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1257 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1258 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260noepoll
1261 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1262 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001263 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001264
1265nokqueue
1266 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1267 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1268 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1269
1270nopoll
1271 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1272 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001274 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001275
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001276nosplice
1277 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1278 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1279 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001280 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001281 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1282 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1283 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1284 "option splice-response".
1285
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001286nogetaddrinfo
1287 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1288 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1289
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001290noreuseport
1291 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1292 command line argument "-dR".
1293
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001294spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001295 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1296 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1297 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1298 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1299 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1300 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001301
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001302ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1303 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1304 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1305 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1306 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1307 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1308 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1309 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1310 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1311 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1312 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1313 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1314 openssl configuration file uses:
1315 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1316
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001317ssl-mode-async
1318 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001319 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001320 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1321 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1322 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1323 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1324 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001325
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001326tune.buffers.limit <number>
1327 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1328 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1329 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1330 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1331 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1332 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1333 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1334 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1335 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1336 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1337 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1338 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1339 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1340 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1341 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1342
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001343tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1344 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1345 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1346 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1347 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1348
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001349tune.bufsize <number>
1350 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1351 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1352 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1353 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1354 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1355 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1356 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001357 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1358 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1359 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001360 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1361 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001362
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001363tune.chksize <number>
1364 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1365 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1366 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1367 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1368 checks whenever possible.
1369
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001370tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1371 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1372 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1373 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1374 this value. The default value is 1.
1375
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001376tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1377 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1378 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1379 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1380 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1381 change it.
1382
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001383tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1384 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
1385 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgement from haproxy. This setting
1386 only affects payload contents (ie: the body of POST requests), not headers.
1387 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1388 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1389 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1390 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1391 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1392
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001393tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1394 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1395 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1396 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1397 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1398 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1399 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1400 recommended not to change this value.
1401
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001402tune.http.cookielen <number>
1403 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1404 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1405 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1406 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1407 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1408 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1409 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1410 to change this value.
1411
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001412tune.http.logurilen <number>
1413 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1414 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1415 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1416 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1417 configuration directives too.
1418 The default value is 1024.
1419
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001420tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1421 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1422 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1423 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1424 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1425 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1426 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001427 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1428 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1429 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001430
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001431tune.idletimer <timeout>
1432 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1433 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1434 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1435 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1436 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1437 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1438 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1439 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1440 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1441
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001442tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1443 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001444 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001445 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1446 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1447 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1448 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1449 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1450
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001451tune.lua.maxmem
1452 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1453 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1454 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1455 memory.
1456
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001457tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1458 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001459 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1460 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1461 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001462
1463tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1464 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1465 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1466 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1467 check servers.
1468
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001469tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1470 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1471 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1472 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1473 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1474
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001475tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001476 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1477 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1478 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1479 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1480 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1481 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1482 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1483 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1484 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1485 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001486
1487tune.maxpollevents <number>
1488 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1489 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1490 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1491 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1492 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1493
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001494tune.maxrewrite <number>
1495 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1496 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1497 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1498 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1499 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1500 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1501 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1502 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1503 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1504 bufsize.
1505
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001506tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1507 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1508 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1509 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1510 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1511 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1512 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1513 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1514 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1515 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1516 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1517 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1518 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1519 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1520 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1521 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1522 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1523 setting this parameter to 0.
1524
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001525tune.pipesize <number>
1526 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1527 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1528 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1529 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1530 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1531 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1532
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001533tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1534tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1535 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1536 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1537 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1538 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1539 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1540 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1541 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1542
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001543tune.recv_enough <number>
1544 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1545 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1546 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1547 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1548 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1549
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001550tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1551tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1552 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1553 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1554 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1555 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1556 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1557 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1558 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1559 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1560 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1561 notifying haproxy again.
1562
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001563tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001564 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1565 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1566 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001567 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001568 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1569 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1570 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1571 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1572 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001573 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1574 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001575
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001576tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1577 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1578 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1579 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1580 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1581 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1582 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1583
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001584tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1585 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001586 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001587 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1588 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1589 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1590 being used for too long.
1591
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001592tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1593 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1594 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1595 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1596 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1597 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1598 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1599 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1600 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1601 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1602 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001603 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1604 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001605
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001606tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1607 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1608 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1609 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1610 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1611 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1612 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1613 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001614 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1615 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001616
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001617tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1618 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1619 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1620 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1621 1000 entries.
1622
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001623tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1624 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1625 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1626 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1627
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001628tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001629tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001630tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1631tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1632tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001633 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1634 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1635 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1636 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1637 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1638 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1639 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1640 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001641
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001642 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1643 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1644 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1645 all available space is consumed.
1646 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1647 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1648 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001649
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001650tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1651 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001652 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001653 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1654 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1655 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1656
1657tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1658 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1659 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1660 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1661 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016633.3. Debugging
1664--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665
1666debug
1667 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1668 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1669 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1670 system startup.
1671
1672quiet
1673 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1674 line argument "-q".
1675
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016773.4. Userlists
1678--------------
1679It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1680http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1681it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1682
1683userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001684 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001685 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1686
1687group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001688 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001689 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1690 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1691
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001692user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1693 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001694 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1695 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001696 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1697 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1698 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1699 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001700
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001701 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1702 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1703 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1704 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1705 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1706 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1707 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1708 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1709 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001710
1711 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001712 userlist L1
1713 group G1 users tiger,scott
1714 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001715
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001716 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1717 user scott insecure-password elgato
1718 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001719
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001720 userlist L2
1721 group G1
1722 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001723
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001724 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1725 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1726 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001727
1728 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001730
17313.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001732----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001733It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1734several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1735instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1736values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1737automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1738In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1739using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1740tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1741reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1742Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1743that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1744each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001745
1746peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001747 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001748 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1749
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001750disabled
1751 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1752 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1753 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1754
1755enable
1756 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1757
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001758peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1759 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1760 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1761 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1762 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1763 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1764 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1765
1766 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1767 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1768
1769 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1770 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1771 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1772 across all peers.
1773
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001774 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1775 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001776
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001777 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001778 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001779 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1780 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1781 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001782
1783 backend mybackend
1784 mode tcp
1785 balance roundrobin
1786 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1787 stick on src
1788
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001789 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1790 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001791
1792
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017933.6. Mailers
1794------------
1795It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1796If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1797in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1798
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001799mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001800 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1801 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1802
1803mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1804 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1805
1806 Example:
1807 mailers mymailers
1808 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1809 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1810
1811 backend mybackend
1812 mode tcp
1813 balance roundrobin
1814
1815 email-alert mailers mymailers
1816 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1817 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1818
1819 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1820 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1821
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001822timeout mail <time>
1823 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1824 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1825 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1826 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1827
1828 Example:
1829 mailers mymailers
1830 timeout mail 20s
1831 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001834----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001836Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001837 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001838 - frontend <name>
1839 - backend <name>
1840 - listen <name>
1841
1842A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1843its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1844section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001846
1847A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1848connections.
1849
1850A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1851to forward incoming connections.
1852
1853A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1854parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1857'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1858case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1859
1860Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1861logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1862proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1863However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1864name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1865
1866Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1867and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001868bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1870modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1871arbitrary criteria.
1872
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001873In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1874a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1875the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1876
1877 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1878 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1879 between responses and new requests.
1880
1881 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1882 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1883 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1884 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1885
1886 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1887 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1888 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1889
1890 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1891 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1892 client-facing connection remains open.
1893
1894 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1895 after the end of the response.
1896
1897The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1898frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1899following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1900weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1901
1902 Backend mode
1903
1904 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1905 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1906 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1907 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1908 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1909 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1910 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1911 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1912 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1913 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1914 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019184.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1919--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001921The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1922limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1923they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1924limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001925marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001926option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001927and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1928with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1929specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001931
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001932 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1933------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1934acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001935appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936backlog X X X -
1937balance X - X X
1938bind - X X -
1939bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001940block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001941capture cookie - X X -
1942capture request header - X X -
1943capture response header - X X -
1944clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001945compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001946contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1947cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001948declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001949default-server X - X X
1950default_backend X X X -
1951description - X X X
1952disabled X X X X
1953dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001954email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001955email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001956email-alert mailers X X X X
1957email-alert myhostname X X X X
1958email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001959enabled X X X X
1960errorfile X X X X
1961errorloc X X X X
1962errorloc302 X X X X
1963-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1964errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001965force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001966filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001967fullconn X - X X
1968grace X X X X
1969hash-type X - X X
1970http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001971http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001972http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001973http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001974http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001975http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001976http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001977id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001978ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001979load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001980log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001981log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001982log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001983log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001984max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001985maxconn X X X -
1986mode X X X X
1987monitor fail - X X -
1988monitor-net X X X -
1989monitor-uri X X X -
1990option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1991option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1992option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1993option allbackups (*) X - X X
1994option checkcache (*) X - X X
1995option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1996option contstats (*) X X X -
1997option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1998option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1999option forceclose (*) X X X X
2000-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2001option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002002option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002003option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002004option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002005option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002006option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002007option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002008option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002009option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2010option httpchk X - X X
2011option httpclose (*) X X X X
2012option httplog X X X X
2013option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002014option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002015option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002016option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002017option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2018option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2019option logasap (*) X X X -
2020option mysql-check X - X X
2021option nolinger (*) X X X X
2022option originalto X X X X
2023option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002024option pgsql-check X - X X
2025option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002027option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002028option smtpchk X - X X
2029option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2030option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2031option splice-request (*) X X X X
2032option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002033option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002034option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2035option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2036-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002037option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002038option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2039option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2040option tcpka X X X X
2041option tcplog X X X X
2042option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002043external-check command X - X X
2044external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002045persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2046rate-limit sessions X X X -
2047redirect - X X X
2048redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2049redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2050reqadd - X X X
2051reqallow - X X X
2052reqdel - X X X
2053reqdeny - X X X
2054reqiallow - X X X
2055reqidel - X X X
2056reqideny - X X X
2057reqipass - X X X
2058reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002059reqitarpit - X X X
2060reqpass - X X X
2061reqrep - X X X
2062-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002063reqtarpit - X X X
2064retries X - X X
2065rspadd - X X X
2066rspdel - X X X
2067rspdeny - X X X
2068rspidel - X X X
2069rspideny - X X X
2070rspirep - X X X
2071rsprep - X X X
2072server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002073server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002074server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002075source X - X X
2076srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002077stats admin - X X X
2078stats auth X X X X
2079stats enable X X X X
2080stats hide-version X X X X
2081stats http-request - X X X
2082stats realm X X X X
2083stats refresh X X X X
2084stats scope X X X X
2085stats show-desc X X X X
2086stats show-legends X X X X
2087stats show-node X X X X
2088stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002089-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2090stick match - - X X
2091stick on - - X X
2092stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002093stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002094stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002095tcp-check connect - - X X
2096tcp-check expect - - X X
2097tcp-check send - - X X
2098tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002099tcp-request connection - X X -
2100tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002101tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002102tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002103tcp-response content - - X X
2104tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002105timeout check X - X X
2106timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002107timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002108timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2109timeout connect X - X X
2110timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2111timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2112timeout http-request X X X X
2113timeout queue X - X X
2114timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002115timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002116timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2117timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002118timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002119transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002120unique-id-format X X X -
2121unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002122use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002123use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002124------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2125 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021284.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2129---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130
2131This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2132
2133
2134acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2135 Declare or complete an access list.
2136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2137 no | yes | yes | yes
2138 Example:
2139 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2140 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2141 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144
2145
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002146appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2147 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2150 no | no | yes | yes
2151 Arguments :
2152 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2153 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2154
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002155 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 checked in each cookie value.
2157
2158 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2159 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2160 milliseconds.
2161
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002162 request-learn
2163 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2164 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2165 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2166 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2167 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2168 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2169
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002170 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2171 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2172 data following this prefix.
2173
2174 Example :
2175 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2176
2177 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2178 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2179
2180 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2181 2 modes are currently supported :
2182 - path-parameters :
2183 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2184 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2185 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2186 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2187 - query-string :
2188 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2189 query string.
2190
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002191 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2192 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2193 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002195 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2196 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197
2198
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002199backlog <conns>
2200 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 yes | yes | yes | no
2203 Arguments :
2204 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2205 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002206 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002207
2208 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2209 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2210 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2211 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2212 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2213 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2214 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2215 backlog parameter.
2216
2217 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2218 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2219 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2220
2221 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2222
2223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002225balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2228 yes | no | yes | yes
2229 Arguments :
2230 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2231 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2232 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2233 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2234
2235 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2236 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2237 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2238 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002239 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002240 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002241 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2242 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2243 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2244 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2245 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2246 it, so that you don't worry.
2247
2248 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2249 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2250 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2251 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2252 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2253 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2254 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2255 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002257 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2258 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2259 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2260 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2261 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2262 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2263 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2264 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2265
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002266 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002267 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002268 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2269 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002270 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002271 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2272 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2273 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2274 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2275 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002276 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2277 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2278 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2279 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2280 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2281 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002282
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2284 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2285 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2286 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2287 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2288 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2289 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2290 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002292 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002293 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2294 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2295 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002297 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2298 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2299 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2300 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2301 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2302 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2303 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2304 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2305 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2306 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2307 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2308 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002310 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002311 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2312 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2313 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2314 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2315 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2316 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2317 URIs start with a leading "/".
2318
2319 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2320 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2321 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2322 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2323
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002325 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2326
2327 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002328 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2329 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002330 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2331 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2332 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2333 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002334 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002335 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2336 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002337
2338 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2339 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2340 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2341 server will receive the request.
2342
2343 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2344 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2345 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2346 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2347 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002348 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2349 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2350 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002352 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2353 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2354 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2355 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2356 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002358 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002359 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2360 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2361 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2362
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002363 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2364 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2365 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2366
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002367 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002368 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002369 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2370 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2371 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2372 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2373 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2374 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002375 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002376 used instead.
2377
2378 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2379 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2380 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2381 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2382
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002383 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2384 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2385 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2386
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002387 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002390 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2391 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002392
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002393 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2394 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2395 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396
2397 Examples :
2398 balance roundrobin
2399 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002400 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002401 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2402 balance hdr(host)
2403 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002404
2405 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2406 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002408 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002409 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2410 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2411 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2412 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2413
2414 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2415 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2416 defaults to 16 kB.
2417
2418 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2419 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2420
2421 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2422 Round Robin.
2423
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002424 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002425 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2426 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2427 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2428
2429 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2430
2431 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002432 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002433 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2434 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2435 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002437 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438
2439
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002440bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2441bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2444 no | yes | yes | no
2445 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002446 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2447 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2448 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2449 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002450 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002451 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2452 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2453 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2454 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2455 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2456 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2457 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002458 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2459 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2460 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2461 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2462 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2463 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2464 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002465 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2466 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2467 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2469 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2470 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002471
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002472 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2473 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002474 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2475 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2476 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002477 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2478 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2479 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2480 the range.
2481
2482 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2483 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2484 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2485 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2486 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2487 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2488 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002489 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002490 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002492 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2493 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2494 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2495 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2496 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2497 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2498 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2499 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002501 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2502 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2503 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2504 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2507 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2508 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2509 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2510 in a frontend.
2511
2512 Example :
2513 listen http_proxy
2514 bind :80,:443
2515 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002516 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002518 listen http_https_proxy
2519 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002520 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002521
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002522 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2523 bind ipv6@:80
2524 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2525 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2526
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002527 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002528 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002529
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002530 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2531 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2532 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2533 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2534 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2535
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002536 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002537 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538
2539
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002540bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002541 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 yes | yes | yes | yes
2544 Arguments :
2545 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2546 may be used to override a default value.
2547
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002548 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002549 option may be combined with other numbers.
2550
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002551 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002552 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2553 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2554 missing from all processes.
2555
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002556 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002557 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002558 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2559 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2560 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2561 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002562
2563 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2564 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2565 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2566 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2567 and 'even' instances.
2568
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002569 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2570 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2571 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2572 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002573
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002574 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2575 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2576
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002577 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2578 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2579 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2580
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002581 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2582 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2583
2584 Example :
2585 listen app_ip1
2586 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002587 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002588
2589 listen app_ip2
2590 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002591 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002592
2593 listen management
2594 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002595 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002596
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002597 listen management
2598 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2599 bind-process 1-4
2600
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002601 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002602
2603
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002604block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2607 no | yes | yes | yes
2608
2609 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2610 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002611 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002612 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002614 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2615 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2616 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002618 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2619 "http-request deny" instead.
2620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002621 Example:
2622 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2623 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2624 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002625 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2626 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2627 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002629 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2630 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2631 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632
2633capture cookie <name> len <length>
2634 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2636 no | yes | yes | no
2637 Arguments :
2638 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2639 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2640 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2641 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2642 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2643
2644 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2645 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2646 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2647 right if it exceeds <length>.
2648
2649 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2650 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2651 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2652 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2653
2654 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2655 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2656 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2657
2658 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2659 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2660 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002661 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2662 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2663 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664
2665 Example:
2666 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2667
2668 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002669 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670
2671
2672capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002673 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2675 no | yes | yes | no
2676 Arguments :
2677 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002678 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002679 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2680 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2681 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2682
2683 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2684 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2685 it exceeds <length>.
2686
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002687 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2689 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002690 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2691 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2692 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2693 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002694 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002695 environments to find where the request came from.
2696
2697 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2698 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2699 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2700 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002702 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2703 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2704 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2705 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2706 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
2708 Example:
2709 capture request header Host len 15
2710 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002711 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002713 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714 about logging.
2715
2716
2717capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002718 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2720 no | yes | yes | no
2721 Arguments :
2722 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002723 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2725 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2726 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2727
2728 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2729 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2730 it exceeds <length>.
2731
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002732 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2734 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2735 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002736 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2737 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2738 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2739 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002741 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2742 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2743 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2744 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2745 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746
2747 Example:
2748 capture response header Content-length len 9
2749 capture response header Location len 15
2750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002751 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002752 about logging.
2753
2754
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002755clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2758 yes | yes | yes | no
2759 Arguments :
2760 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2761 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2762 as explained at the top of this document.
2763
2764 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2765 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2766 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2767 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2768 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2769 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2770 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2771 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002772 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002773 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2774 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2775
2776 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2777 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2778 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2779 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2780 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2781 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2782
2783 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2784 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2785
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002786 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2787 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002789compression algo <algorithm> ...
2790compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002791compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002792 Enable HTTP compression.
2793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2794 yes | yes | yes | yes
2795 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002796 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2797 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2798 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2799
2800 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002801 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2802 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2803 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002804
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002805 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002806 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002807
2808 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2809 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2810 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2811 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2812 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002813 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002814
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002815 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2816 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2817 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2818 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2819 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2820 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2821 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002822 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002823
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002824 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002825 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002826 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2827 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2828 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2829 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2830 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002831
2832 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2833 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2834 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2835 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2836 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002837 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2838 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2839 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2840 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2841 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002842 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2843 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002844
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002845 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002846 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2847 "Accept-Encoding" header
2848 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002849 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002850 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2851 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002852 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2853 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2854 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2855 "multipart"
2856 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2857 header
2858 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2859 and later
2860 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2861 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002862
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002863 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2864 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002865
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002866 Examples :
2867 compression algo gzip
2868 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002870
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002871contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2874 yes | no | yes | yes
2875 Arguments :
2876 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2877 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2878 as explained at the top of this document.
2879
2880 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002881 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002882 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002883 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2884 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2885 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2886 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2887
2888 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2890 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2891 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2892 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2893 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2894
2895 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2896 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2897 instead.
2898
2899 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2900 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2901
2902
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002903cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002904 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2905 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002906 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002907 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2909 yes | no | yes | yes
2910 Arguments :
2911 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2912 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2913 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2914 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2915 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2916 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2917 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2918 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2919 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2920
2921 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2922 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2923 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2924 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2925 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2926 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002927 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2928 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2929 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2930 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2931 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932
2933 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002934 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002935
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002936 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002937 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2938 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2939 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2940 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2941 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2942 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2943 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2944 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2945 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2946 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947
2948 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2949 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2950 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2951 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2952 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2953 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2954 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2955 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2956 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002957 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002958 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2959 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2960 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002962 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2963 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2964 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002965 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2966 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2967 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2968 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002969 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2970 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2971 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002972
2973 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2974 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2975 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2976 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2977 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2978 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2979 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2980 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2981 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2982
2983 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2984 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2985 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2986 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2987 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2988 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2989 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2990 persistence cookie in the cache.
2991 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2992
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002993 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2994 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2995 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2996 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2997 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2998 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2999 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3000 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3001 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3002 they logout.
3003
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003004 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3005 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3006 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3007 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3008
3009 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3010 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3011 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3012 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3013 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3014 this attribute.
3015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003016 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003017 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003018 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3019 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3020 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3021 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3022 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3023 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003024
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003025 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3026 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3027 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3028 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3029 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3030 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3031 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3032 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3033 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
3034 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3035 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3036 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3037 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3038 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3039 the site.
3040
3041 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3042 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3043 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3044 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3045 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3046 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3047 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3048 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3049 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3050 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3051 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3052 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3053 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3054 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3055 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3056 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3057
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003058 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3059 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3060 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3061 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3062 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3063 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3066 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3067 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3068 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 Examples :
3071 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3072 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3073 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003074 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003076 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003078
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003079declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3080 Declares a capture slot.
3081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3082 no | yes | yes | no
3083 Arguments:
3084 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3085
3086 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3087 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3088 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3089 for use in the response.
3090
3091 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003092 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003093 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3094
3095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003096default-server [param*]
3097 Change default options for a server in a backend
3098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3099 yes | no | yes | yes
3100 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003101 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3102 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3103 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3104 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003105
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003106 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003107 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3108
3109 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003110
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003111
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112default_backend <backend>
3113 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 yes | yes | yes | no
3116 Arguments :
3117 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3118
3119 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3120 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3121 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3122 will catch all undetermined requests.
3123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 Example :
3125
3126 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3127 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3128 default_backend dynamic
3129
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003130 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003131
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003133description <string>
3134 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 no | yes | yes | yes
3137 Arguments : string
3138
3139 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3140 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3141 it describes.
3142 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3143
3144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145disabled
3146 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3148 yes | yes | yes | yes
3149 Arguments : none
3150
3151 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3152 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3153 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3154 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3155 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3156 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3157 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3158
3159 See also : "enabled"
3160
3161
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003162dispatch <address>:<port>
3163 Set a default server address
3164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3165 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003166 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003167
3168 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3169 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3170 during start-up.
3171
3172 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3173 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3174 possible with normal servers.
3175
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003176 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003177 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3178 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3179 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3180 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3181
3182 See also : "server"
3183
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003184
3185dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3186 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | no | yes | yes
3189 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3190
3191 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3192 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3193 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3194 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3195 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3196 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003198enabled
3199 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3201 yes | yes | yes | yes
3202 Arguments : none
3203
3204 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3205 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3206
3207 See also : "disabled"
3208
3209
3210errorfile <code> <file>
3211 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3213 yes | yes | yes | yes
3214 Arguments :
3215 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003216 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3217 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003218
3219 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003220 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003221 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003222 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3223 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
3225 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3226 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3227 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3228
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003229 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003231 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3232 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3233 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3234 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3235
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003236 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3237 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3238 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3239 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3240 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3241 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003243 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3244 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3245 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003246 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3248
3249 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3250
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003251 Example :
3252 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003253 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003254 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3255 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3256
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003257
3258errorloc <code> <url>
3259errorloc302 <code> <url>
3260 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 yes | yes | yes | yes
3263 Arguments :
3264 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003265 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3266 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003267
3268 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3269 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3270 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3271 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3272 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3273
3274 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3275 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3276 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3277
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003278 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3279
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003280 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3281 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3282 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3283 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003284 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003285 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3286 request.
3287
3288 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3289
3290
3291errorloc303 <code> <url>
3292 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3294 yes | yes | yes | yes
3295 Arguments :
3296 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003297 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3298 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003299
3300 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3301 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3302 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3303 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3304 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3305
3306 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3307 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3308 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3309
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003310 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3311
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003312 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3313 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3314 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3315 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003316 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003317
3318 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3319
3320
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003321email-alert from <emailaddr>
3322 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3323 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3325 yes | yes | yes | yes
3326
3327 Arguments :
3328
3329 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3330
3331 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3332 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3333
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003334 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003335 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3336 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003337
3338
3339email-alert level <level>
3340 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3341 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3343 yes | yes | yes | yes
3344
3345 Arguments :
3346
3347 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3348 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3349 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3350
3351 By default level is alert
3352
3353 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3354 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3355 for the proxy.
3356
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003357 Alerts are sent when :
3358
3359 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3360 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3361 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3362 is notice or lower
3363 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3364 and a health check status update occurs
3365
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003366 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3367 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003368 section 3.6 about mailers.
3369
3370
3371email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3372 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 yes | yes | yes | yes
3375
3376 Arguments :
3377
3378 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3379
3380 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3381 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3382
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003383 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3384 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003385
3386
3387email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3388 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3389 mailers.
3390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | yes | yes | yes
3392
3393 Arguments :
3394
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003395 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003396
3397 By default the systems hostname is used.
3398
3399 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3400 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3401 for the proxy.
3402
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003403 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3404 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003405
3406
3407email-alert to <emailaddr>
3408 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3409 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3410 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3411 yes | yes | yes | yes
3412
3413 Arguments :
3414
3415 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3416
3417 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3418 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3419
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003420 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003421 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3422
3423
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003424force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3425 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 no | yes | yes | yes
3428
3429 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3430 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3431 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3432 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3433 marked down for maintenance operations.
3434
3435 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3436 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3437 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3438 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3439 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3440 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3441 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3442 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3443 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3444
3445 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3446 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3447 is used.
3448
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003449 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003450 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003451
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003452
3453filter <name> [param*]
3454 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 no | yes | yes | yes
3457 Arguments :
3458 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3459 referenced in section 9.
3460
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003461 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003462 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003463 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3464 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003465
3466 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3467 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3468
3469 Example:
3470 listen
3471 bind *:80
3472
3473 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3474 filter compression
3475 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3476
3477 compression algo gzip
3478 compression offload
3479
3480 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3481
3482 See also : section 9.
3483
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003485fullconn <conns>
3486 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3488 yes | no | yes | yes
3489 Arguments :
3490 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3491 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3492
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003493 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003495 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003496 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3497 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3498 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3499 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3500 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003501 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003502
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003503 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3504 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003505 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3506 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3507 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003509 Example :
3510 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3511 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3512 # connections.
3513 backend dynamic
3514 fullconn 10000
3515 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3516 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3517
3518 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3519
3520
3521grace <time>
3522 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003524 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003525 Arguments :
3526 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3527 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3528 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3529
3530 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3531 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003532 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003533 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3534
3535 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3536 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3537 simplify it.
3538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003540hash-balance-factor <factor>
3541 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | no | no | yes
3544 Arguments :
3545 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3546 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3547 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3548
3549 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3550 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3551 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3552 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3553 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3554 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3555 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3556
3557 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3558 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3559 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3560 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3561 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3562
3563 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3564
3565
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003566hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003567 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | no | yes | yes
3570 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003571 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3572 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003573
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003574 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3575 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3576 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3577 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3578 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3579 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3580 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3581 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3582 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3583 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003584
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003585 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3586 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3587 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3588 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3589 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3590 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3591 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3592 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3593 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3594 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3595 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3596 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3597 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003598 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3599 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003600
3601 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3602
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003603 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003604 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3605 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3606 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003607 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3608 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3609 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003610
3611 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3612 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003613 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3614 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3615 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3616 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3617
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003618 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3619 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3620 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3621 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3622 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3623 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3624 parameter.
3625
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003626 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3627 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3628 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3629 used on strings.
3630
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003631 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3632
3633 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3634 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3635 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3636 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3637 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3638 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3639 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3640 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3641 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3642 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3643 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3644 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003645
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003646 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3647 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3648 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003649
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003650 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003651
3652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653http-check disable-on-404
3654 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003656 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657 Arguments : none
3658
3659 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3660 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3661 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3662 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3663 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3664 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3665 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3666 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003667 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3668 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3669 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3670
3671 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3672
3673
3674http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003675 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003677 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003678 Arguments :
3679 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3680 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003681 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003682 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3683 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3684 details on the supported keywords.
3685
3686 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3687 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3688 with the usual backslash ('\').
3689
3690 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3691 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3692 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3693 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3694 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3695
3696 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003697 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003698 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3699 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3700 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3701
3702 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003703 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003704 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3705 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3706 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3707 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3708
3709 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003710 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003711 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3712 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3713 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3714 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3715 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3716 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3717 trace).
3718
3719 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003720 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003721 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3722 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3723 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3724 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3725 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3726 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3727
3728 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3729 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3730 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3731 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3732 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3733 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3734 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3735 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3736
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003737 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3738 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3739 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3740
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003741 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3742 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3743
3744 Examples :
3745 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003746 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003747
3748 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003749 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003750
3751 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003752 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003753
3754 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003755 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003757 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003760http-check send-state
3761 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 yes | no | yes | yes
3764 Arguments : none
3765
3766 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3767 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3768 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3769 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3770 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3771
3772 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3773 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3774 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3775 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3776 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003777 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3778 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3779 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3780
3781 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3782 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3783 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3784
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003785 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3786 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3787 checked in multiple backends.
3788
3789 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3790 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3791
3792 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3793 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3794 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3795 one fails.
3796
3797 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3798 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3799 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3800
3801 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3802 server's queue.
3803
3804 Example of a header received by the application server :
3805 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3806 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3807
3808 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3809
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003810http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003811 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003812 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003813 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003814 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003815 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3816 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003817 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3818 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003819 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3820 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3821 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003822 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003823 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003824 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003825 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003826 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003827 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003828 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003829 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003830 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003831 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003832 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3833
3834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3835 no | yes | yes | yes
3836
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003837 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3838 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3839 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3840 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3841 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003842
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003843 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3844 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3845 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3846
3847 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003848 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3849 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3850 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3851 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003852
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003853 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3854 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3855 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3856 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3857
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003858 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3859 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3860 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003861 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3862 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003863 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3864 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3865 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3866 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3867 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003868 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003869 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3870 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003871
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003872 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3873 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3874 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3875 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3876 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3877
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003878 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3879 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3880 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003881 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3882 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003884 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3885 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3886 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3887 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3888 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3889 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3890 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3891 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3892
3893 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3894 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3895 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003896 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3897 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003898
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003899 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3900 <name>.
3901
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003902 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3903 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3904 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3905 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3906 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3907 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3908 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3909 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3910
3911 Example:
3912
3913 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3914
3915 applied to:
3916
3917 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3918
3919 outputs:
3920
3921 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3922
3923 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3924
3925 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3926 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3927 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3928 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3929 header.
3930
3931 Example:
3932
3933 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3934
3935 applied to:
3936
3937 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3938
3939 outputs:
3940
3941 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3942
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003943 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3944 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3945 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3946 it.
3947
3948 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3949 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3950 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3951 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3952 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3953 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3954
3955 Example :
3956 # prepend the host name before the path
3957 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3958
3959 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3960 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3961 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3962 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3963 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3964 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3965 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3966 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3967
3968 Example :
3969 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3970 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3971
3972 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3973 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3974 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3975 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3976 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3977 "set-query".
3978
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003979 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3980 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3981 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3982 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3983 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3984 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3985 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3986 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3987
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003988 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3989 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3990 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3991 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3992 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3993 another equipment.
3994
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003995 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3996 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3997 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3998 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3999 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4000 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4001 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4002 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4003
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004004 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4005 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4006 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4007 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4008 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4009 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4010 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4011 admin privileges.
4012
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004013 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4014 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4015 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4016 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4017 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4018 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4019 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4020 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4021
4022 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4023 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4024 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4025 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4026 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4027 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4028
4029 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4030 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4031 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4032 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4033 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4034 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4035
4036 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4037 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4038 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4039 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4040 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4041 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4042 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4043 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4044 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4045
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004046 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004047 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4048 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4049 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4050 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4051 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4052 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4053 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4054 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4055 request header" for more information.
4056
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004057 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4058 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4059 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4060 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004061 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4062 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004063
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004064 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4065 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4066 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4067 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4068 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4069 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4070 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4071 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4072 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4073 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4074 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4075 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4076
4077 These actions take one or two arguments :
4078 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4079 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4080 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4081 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4082
4083 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4084 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4085 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4086 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4087
4088 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4089 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4090 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4091 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4092 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4093 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4094 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4095 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4096
4097 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4098 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4099 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4100 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4101 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4102
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004103 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4104 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4105 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4106 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4107 continues.
4108
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004109 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4110 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4111 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4112 the actions evaluation continues.
4113
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004114 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4115 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4116 inline.
4117
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004118 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4119 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004120 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004121 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4122 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004123 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004124 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004125 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004126 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4127 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004128 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004129 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004130 and '_'.
4131
4132 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4133 followed by some converters.
4134
4135 Example:
4136
4137 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4138
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004139 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4140 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4141
4142 Example:
4143
4144 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4145
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004146 - set-src <expr> :
4147 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4148 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4149 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4150 source IP for privacy.
4151
4152 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4153 followed by some converters.
4154
4155 Example:
4156
4157 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4158 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4159
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004160 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4161 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004162
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004163 - set-src-port <expr> :
4164 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4165 expression.
4166
4167 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4168 followed by some converters.
4169
4170 Example:
4171
4172 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4173 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4174
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004175 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4176 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4177 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004178
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004179 - set-dst <expr> :
4180 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4181 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4182 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4183 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4184 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4185
4186 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4187 followed by some converters.
4188
4189 Example:
4190
4191 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4192 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4193
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004194 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4195 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4196
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004197 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4198 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4199 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4200 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4201
4202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4203 followed by some converters.
4204
4205 Example:
4206
4207 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4208 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4209
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004210 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4211 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4212 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4213
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004214 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4215 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4216 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4217 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4218 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4219 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4220 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4221 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4222 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4223 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4224 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4225 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4226 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4227 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4228 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4229 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4230
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004231
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004232 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4233 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4234 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4235
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004236 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4237 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4238 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4239 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4240 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4241 SPOE agent name must be used.
4242
4243 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4244
4245 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4246 configuration.
4247
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004248 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4249
4250 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4251 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004252 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4253 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4254
4255 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4256 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4257 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4258 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004259
4260 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004261 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4262 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4263 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004264
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004265 http-request allow if nagios
4266 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4267 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4268 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004269
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004270 Example:
4271 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004272 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004273
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004274 Example:
4275 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4276 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004277 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004278 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4279 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4280 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4281 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4282 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4283 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4284
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004285 Example:
4286 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4287 acl add path /addacl
4288 acl del path /delacl
4289
4290 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4291
4292 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4293 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4294
4295 Example:
4296 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4297 acl setmap path /setmap
4298 acl delmap path /delmap
4299
4300 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4301
4302 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4303 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4304
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004305 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4306 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004307
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004308http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004309 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004310 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004311 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4312 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004313 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004314 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4315 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4316 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4317 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004318 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004319 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004320 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004321 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004322 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004323 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004324 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004325 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004326 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004327 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004328 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4329
4330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 no | yes | yes | yes
4332
4333 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4334 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4335 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4336 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4337 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4338 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4339
4340 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4341 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4342 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4343 current section.
4344
4345 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4346 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4347 rules are evaluated.
4348
4349 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4350 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4351 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4352 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4353 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4354 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4355 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4356
4357 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4358 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4359 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4360 external users.
4361
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004362 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4363 <name>.
4364
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004365 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4366 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4367 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4368 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4369 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4370 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4371 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4372 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4373
4374 Example:
4375
4376 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4377
4378 applied to:
4379
4380 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4381
4382 outputs:
4383
4384 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4385
4386 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4387
4388 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4389 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4390 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4391 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4392 header.
4393
4394 Example:
4395
4396 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4397
4398 applied to:
4399
4400 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4401
4402 outputs:
4403
4404 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4405
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004406 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004407 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4408 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4409 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004410
4411 Example:
4412
4413 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4414 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004415 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4416 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004417
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004418 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4419 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4420 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4421 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4422 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4423 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4424 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4425 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4426
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004427 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4428 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4429 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4430 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4431 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4432 another equipment.
4433
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004434 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4435 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4436 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4437 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4438 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4439 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4440 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4441 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4442
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004443 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4444 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4445 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4446 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4447 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4448 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4449 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4450 admin privileges.
4451
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004452 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4453 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4454 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4455 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4456 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4457 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4458 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4459 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4460
4461 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4462 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4463 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4464 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4465 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4466 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4467
4468 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4469 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4470 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4471 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4472 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4473 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4474
4475 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4476 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4477 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4478 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4479 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4480 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4481 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4482 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4483 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4484
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004485 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4486 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4487 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4488 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4489 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4490 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4491 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4492 response header" for more information.
4493
4494 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4495 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4496 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4497 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4498 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004499 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4500 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004501
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004502 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4503 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4504 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4505 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4506 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4507 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4508
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004509 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4510 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4511 inline.
4512
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004513 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4514 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004515 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004516 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4517 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004518 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004519 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004520 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004521 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4522 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004523 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004524 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4525 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004526
4527 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4528 followed by some converters.
4529
4530 Example:
4531
4532 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4533
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004534 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4535 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4536
4537 Example:
4538
4539 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4540
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004541 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4542 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4543 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4544 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4545 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4546 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4547 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4548
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004549 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4550 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4551 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4552 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4553 continues.
4554
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004555 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4556 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4557 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4558 the actions evaluation continues.
4559
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004560 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4561 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4562 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4563 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4564 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4565 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4566 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4567 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4568 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4569 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4570 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4571 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4572 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4573 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4574 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4575 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4576
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004577 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4578 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4579 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4580 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4581 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4582 SPOE agent name must be used.
4583
4584 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4585
4586 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4587 configuration.
4588
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004589 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4590
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004591 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004592 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4593 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004594 rules.
4595
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004596 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4597 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4598 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4599 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4600
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004601 Example:
4602 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4603
4604 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4605
4606 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4607 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4608
4609 Example:
4610 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4611
4612 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4613
4614 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4615 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4616
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004617 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4618 ACL usage.
4619
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004620
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004621http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4622 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4623
4624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 yes | no | yes | yes
4626
4627 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4628 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4629 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4630 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4631 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4632 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4633
4634 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4635
4636 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4637 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4638 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4639 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4640 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4641 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4642 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4643 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4644 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4645 not checking any request past the first one.
4646
4647 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4648 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4649 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4650 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4651 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4652 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4653 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4654
4655 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4656 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4657 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4658 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4659 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4660 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4661 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4662 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4663 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4664 downsides of rare connection failures.
4665
4666 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4667 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4668 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4669 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4670 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4671 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4672 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4673 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4674 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4675 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4676 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4677 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4678
4679 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4680 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4681 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4682 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4683
4684 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4685 and are never shared ;
4686
4687 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4688 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4689 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4690 and are never shared ;
4691
4692 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4693 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4694 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4695
4696 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4697 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4698 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4699
4700 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4701
4702
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004703http-send-name-header [<header>]
4704 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4705
4706 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 yes | no | yes | yes
4708
4709 Arguments :
4710
4711 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4712
4713 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4714 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4715 is added with the header string proved.
4716
4717 See also : "server"
4718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004719id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004720 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 no | yes | yes | yes
4723 Arguments : none
4724
4725 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4726 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4727 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004728
4729
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004730ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4731 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 no | yes | yes | yes
4734
4735 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4736 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4737 and running).
4738
4739 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4740 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4741 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004742 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004743 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4744
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004745 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4746 "unless" condition is met.
4747
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004748 Example:
4749 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4750 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4751 ignore-persist if url_static
4752
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004753 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4754
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004755load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4756 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | no | yes | yes
4759
4760 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4761 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4762 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4763 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4764 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4765 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4766 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4767 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4768
4769 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4770 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004771 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004772
4773 Arguments:
4774 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4775 named "server-state-file".
4776
4777 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4778 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4779 name is used as a file name.
4780
4781 none don't load any stat for this backend
4782
4783 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004784 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4785 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4786 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4787 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4788 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004789
4790 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4791 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4792
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004793 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004794
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004795 global
4796 stats socket /tmp/socket
4797 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004798
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004799 defaults
4800 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004801
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004802 backend bk
4803 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4804 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004805
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004806
4807 Then one can run :
4808
4809 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4810
4811 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4812
4813 1
4814 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4815 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4816 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4817
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004818 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004819
4820 global
4821 stats socket /tmp/socket
4822 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4823
4824 defaults
4825 load-server-state-from-file local
4826
4827 backend bk
4828 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4829 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4830
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004831
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004832 Then one can run :
4833
4834 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4835
4836 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4837
4838 1
4839 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4840 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4841 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4842
4843 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4844 "show servers state"
4845
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004846
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004847log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004848log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004849no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004850 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4852 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004853
4854 Prefix :
4855 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4856 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4857 prefix does not allow arguments.
4858
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004859 Arguments :
4860 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4861 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4862 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4863 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4864 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4865 parameter.
4866
4867 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4868 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4869
4870 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4871 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4872 standard syslog port).
4873
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004874 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4875 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4876 standard syslog port).
4877
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004878 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4879 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4880 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4881 appropriately writeable).
4882
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004883 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4884 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004885
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004886 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4887 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4888 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4889 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4890 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4891 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4892 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4893 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4894 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4895 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4896 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004898 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4899
4900 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4901 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4902 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4903
4904 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4905 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4906 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004907 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4908 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4909 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4910 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4911 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004912
4913 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4914
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004915 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4916 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4917 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004918
4919 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4920 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4921 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4922 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4923
4924 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4925 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
4927 Example :
4928 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004929 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4930 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004931 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004934log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004935 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4937 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004938
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004939 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4940 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4941 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4942 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4943 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004944
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004945 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4946 "option httplog" directives.
4947
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004948log-format-sd <string>
4949 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | no
4952
4953 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4954 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4955 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4956 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4957 which covers the log format string in depth.
4958
4959 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4960 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4961
4962 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4963 log format to "rfc5424".
4964
4965 Example :
4966 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4967
4968
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004969log-tag <string>
4970 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | yes | yes | yes
4973
4974 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4975 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4976 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4977 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4978 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4979 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4980 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4981 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4982 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004983
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004984max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4985 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4987 yes | no | yes | yes
4988
4989 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4990 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4991 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4992 servers.
4993
4994 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4995 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4996 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4997 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4998 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4999 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
5000 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5001 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5002 picking a different server.
5003
5004 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5005 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5006 even if they have to be queued.
5007
5008 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5009 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5010
5011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005012maxconn <conns>
5013 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5015 yes | yes | yes | no
5016 Arguments :
5017 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5018 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5019 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5020 closes.
5021
5022 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5023 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5024 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5025 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005026 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5027 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5028 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5029 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005030
5031 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5032 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5033 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5034
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005035 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5036
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5038
5039
5040mode { tcp|http|health }
5041 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5043 yes | yes | yes | yes
5044 Arguments :
5045 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5046 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5047 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5048 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5049
5050 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5051 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5052 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5053 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5054 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5055
5056 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005057 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5058 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5059 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5060 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5061 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5062 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5063 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005064
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005065 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5066 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5067 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005068
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005069 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005070 defaults http_instances
5071 mode http
5072
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005073 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005075
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005076monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005077 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005080 Arguments :
5081 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5082 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005083 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005084 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5085 backend and its backup.
5086
5087 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5088 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5089 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5090 servers in a list of backends.
5091
5092 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5093 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5094 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5095 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5096 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5097 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5098 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005099 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5100 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005101
5102 Example:
5103 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005104 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005105 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5106 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5107 monitor-uri /site_alive
5108 monitor fail if site_dead
5109
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005110 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111
5112
5113monitor-net <source>
5114 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | yes | yes | no
5117 Arguments :
5118 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5119 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5120 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5121 followed by a mask.
5122
5123 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5124 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005125 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005126 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5127
5128 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5129 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5130 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5131 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005132 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5133 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5134 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005136 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5137 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5138 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5139 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5140 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5141 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005142
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005143 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5144 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005145
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146 Example :
5147 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5148 frontend www
5149 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5150
5151 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5152
5153
5154monitor-uri <uri>
5155 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | yes | yes | no
5158 Arguments :
5159 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5160 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5161
5162 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5163 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5164 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5165 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5166 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5167 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5168 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5169 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5170
5171 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5172 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5173 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5174 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5175 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5176 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5177
5178 Example :
5179 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5180 frontend www
5181 mode http
5182 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5183
5184 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005186
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005187option abortonclose
5188no option abortonclose
5189 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | no | yes | yes
5192 Arguments : none
5193
5194 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5195 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5196 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5197 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005198 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005199 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5200 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5201 encountered while delivering the response.
5202
5203 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5204 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5205 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5206 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5207 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5208 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005209 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005210 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005211 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005212 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5213 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5214 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5215
5216 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5217 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5218 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5219 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5220 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5221 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5222 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5223 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005224 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005225
5226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5228
5229 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5230
5231
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005232option accept-invalid-http-request
5233no option accept-invalid-http-request
5234 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | yes | yes | no
5237 Arguments : none
5238
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005239 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005240 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5241 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5242 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5243 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5244 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5245 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5246 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005247 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5248 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5249 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5250 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5251 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005252 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005253 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5254 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5255 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005256
5257 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5258 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5259 been confirmed.
5260
5261 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5262 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005263 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5264 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005265 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5266
5267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5269
5270 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5271 stats socket.
5272
5273
5274option accept-invalid-http-response
5275no option accept-invalid-http-response
5276 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
5279 Arguments : none
5280
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005281 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005282 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5283 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5284 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5285 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5286 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5287 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5288 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005289 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5290 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5291 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005292
5293 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5294 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5295 been confirmed.
5296
5297 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5298 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5299 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5300 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5301
5302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5304
5305 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5306 stats socket.
5307
5308
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005309option allbackups
5310no option allbackups
5311 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 yes | no | yes | yes
5314 Arguments : none
5315
5316 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5317 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5318 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5319 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5320 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5321 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5322 order between the backup servers anymore.
5323
5324 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5325 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5326
5327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5329
5330
5331option checkcache
5332no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005333 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | no | yes | yes
5336 Arguments : none
5337
5338 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5339 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005340 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005341 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5342 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005343 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005344
5345 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005346 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005347 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005348 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5349 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005350 to the client are :
5351 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005352 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005353 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005354 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5355 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5356 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5357 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5358 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5359 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5360 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5361 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5362 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5363 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5364 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5365
5366 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005367 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005368 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005369 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005370 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5371
5372 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5373 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005374 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005375 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5376
5377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5379
5380
5381option clitcpka
5382no option clitcpka
5383 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | yes | yes | no
5386 Arguments : none
5387
5388 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5389 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5390 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5391 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5392
5393 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5394 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5395 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5396 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5397
5398 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5399 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5400 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5401 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5402 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5403
5404 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5405
5406 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5407 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5408 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5409
5410 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5411 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5412
5413 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5414
5415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005416option contstats
5417 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5419 yes | yes | yes | no
5420 Arguments : none
5421
5422 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5423 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5424 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5425 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005426 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5427 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5428 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5429 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5430 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005431
5432
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005433option dontlog-normal
5434no option dontlog-normal
5435 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | yes | yes | no
5438 Arguments : none
5439
5440 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5441 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5442 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5443 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5444 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5445 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5446 logged.
5447
5448 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5449 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5450 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005452 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005453 logging.
5454
5455
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005456option dontlognull
5457no option dontlognull
5458 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | yes | yes | no
5461 Arguments : none
5462
5463 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5464 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5465 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5466 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5467 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5468 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005469 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5470 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5471 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005472
5473 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5474 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5475 would not be logged.
5476
5477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5479
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005480 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5481 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005482
5483
5484option forceclose
5485no option forceclose
5486 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005488 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005489 Arguments : none
5490
5491 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5492 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5493 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5494 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5495 global session times in the logs.
5496
5497 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005498 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005499 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005500
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005501 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5502 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5503 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5504
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005505 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5506 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005507
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5510
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005511 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005512
5513
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005514option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005515 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5517 yes | yes | yes | yes
5518 Arguments :
5519 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5520 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005521 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005522 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005523
5524 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5525 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5526 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5527 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5528 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5529 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5530 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005531 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5532 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5533 possible that the client has already brought one.
5534
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005535 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005536 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005537 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5538 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005539 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5540 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005541
5542 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5543 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5544 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5545 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5546 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5547 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5548 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5549
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005550 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5551 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5552 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5553 are under the control of the end-user.
5554
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005555 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005556 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5557 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005558 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5559 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5560 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005561
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005562 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005563 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5564 frontend www
5565 mode http
5566 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5567
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005568 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5569 backend www
5570 mode http
5571 option forwardfor header X-Client
5572
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005573 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005574 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005575
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005576
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005577option http-buffer-request
5578no option http-buffer-request
5579 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5581 yes | yes | yes | yes
5582 Arguments : none
5583
5584 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5585 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5586 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5587 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5588 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5589 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5590 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5591 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005592 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005593 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5594 default.
5595
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005596 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005597
5598
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005599option http-ignore-probes
5600no option http-ignore-probes
5601 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 yes | yes | yes | no
5604 Arguments : none
5605
5606 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5607 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5608 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5609 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5610 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5611 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5612 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5613 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5614 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5615 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5616 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5617 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5618
5619 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5620 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5621 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5622 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5623 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5624 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5625 are often the only way to detect them.
5626
5627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5629
5630 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5631
5632
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005633option http-keep-alive
5634no option http-keep-alive
5635 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5637 yes | yes | yes | yes
5638 Arguments : none
5639
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005640 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5641 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5642 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5643 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5644 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5645 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5646 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5647
5648 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5649 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005650 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5651 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5652 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5653 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5654 situations where this option may be useful :
5655
5656 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5657 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5658
5659 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5660 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5661
5662 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5663 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5664 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5665 request.
5666
5667 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5668 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005669 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5670 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5671 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005672
5673 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5674 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5675
5676 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5677 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5678 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5679 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5680 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5681 not set.
5682
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005683 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5684 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005685 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005686 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005687
5688 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005689 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5690 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005691
5692
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005693option http-no-delay
5694no option http-no-delay
5695 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5697 yes | yes | yes | yes
5698 Arguments : none
5699
5700 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5701 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5702 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5703 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5704 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5705 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5706 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5707 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5708 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5709 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5710 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5711 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5712 affected.
5713
5714 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5715 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5716 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5717 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5718 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5719 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5720 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5721 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5722 latency environments.
5723
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005724 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5725
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005726
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005727option http-pretend-keepalive
5728no option http-pretend-keepalive
5729 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 yes | yes | yes | yes
5732 Arguments : none
5733
5734 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5735 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5736 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5737 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5738 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5739 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5740 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5741 consider the response complete.
5742
5743 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5744 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5745 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5746 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5747 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5748 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5749
5750 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5751 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5752 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5753 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5754 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5755 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5756 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5757
5758 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5759 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005760 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005761 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5762 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005763
5764 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5765 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5766
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005767 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5768 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005769
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005770
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005771option http-server-close
5772no option http-server-close
5773 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | yes | yes | yes
5776 Arguments : none
5777
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005778 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5779 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5780 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5781 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5782 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5783 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5784 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5785 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5786 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5787 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5788 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005789 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005790 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5791 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5792 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5793 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005794
5795 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5796 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5797 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5798 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005799 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5800 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005801
5802 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5803 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005804 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5805 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005806 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5807 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005808
5809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5811
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005812 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005813 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5814 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005815
5816
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005817option http-tunnel
5818no option http-tunnel
5819 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 yes | yes | yes | yes
5822 Arguments : none
5823
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005824 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5825 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5826 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5827 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5828 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5829 "option http-tunnel".
5830
5831 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005832 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005833 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5834 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5835 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5836 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5837 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5838 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5839 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005840
5841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5843
5844 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5845 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5846 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5847
5848
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005849option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005850no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005851 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5853 yes | yes | yes | no
5854 Arguments : none
5855
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005856 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005857 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5858 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5859 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5860 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5861 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5862 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5863
5864 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5865 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005866 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5867 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5868 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005869
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005870 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5871 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5872 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5873 front of an existing proxy.
5874
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005875 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5876
5877 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5878 http-server-close".
5879
5880
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005881option httpchk
5882option httpchk <uri>
5883option httpchk <method> <uri>
5884option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5885 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | no | yes | yes
5888 Arguments :
5889 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5890 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5891 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5892 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5893 ones.
5894
5895 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5896 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5897 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5898
5899 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5900 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5901 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5902 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5903 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5904
5905 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5906 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5907 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5908 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5909 the lack of any response.
5910
5911 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5912
5913 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5914 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5915 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5916
5917 Examples :
5918 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5919 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5920 backend https_relay
5921 mode tcp
5922 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5923 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5924
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005925 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5926 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5927 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005928
5929
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005930option httpclose
5931no option httpclose
5932 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | yes | yes | yes
5935 Arguments : none
5936
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005937 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5938 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5939 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5940 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005941 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005942 "option http-tunnel".
5943
5944 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5945 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5946 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5947 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5948 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5949 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5950 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5951 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005952
5953 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005954 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005955 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5956 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5957 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5958 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5959 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005960
5961 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5962 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005963 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5964 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005965 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5966 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005967
5968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5970
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005971 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5972 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005973
5974
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005975option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005976 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005979 Arguments :
5980 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5981 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5982 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5983 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5984 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005985
5986 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5987 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5988 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5989 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5990 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5991 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5992 ports.
5993
5994 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5995
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005996 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5997 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005998
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005999 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006001 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006002
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006003
6004option http_proxy
6005no option http_proxy
6006 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | yes | yes | yes
6009 Arguments : none
6010
6011 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6012 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6013 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6014 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6015 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6016
6017 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6018 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006019 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6020 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006021
6022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6024
6025 Example :
6026 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6027 backend direct_forward
6028 option httpclose
6029 option http_proxy
6030
6031 See also : "option httpclose"
6032
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006033
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006034option independent-streams
6035no option independent-streams
6036 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | yes | yes | yes
6039 Arguments : none
6040
6041 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6042 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6043 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6044 receive data or not.
6045
6046 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6047 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6048 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6049 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6050 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6051 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6052 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6053 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6054 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6055 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6056 socket buffers.
6057
6058 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6059 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6060 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6061 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6062 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6063
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006064 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006065 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6066 deprecated.
6067
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006068 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006069
6070
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006071option ldap-check
6072 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6074 yes | no | yes | yes
6075 Arguments : none
6076
6077 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6078 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6079 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6080 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6081
6082 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6083 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6084
6085 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6086 configure it.
6087
6088 Example :
6089 option ldap-check
6090
6091 See also : "option httpchk"
6092
6093
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006094option external-check
6095 Use external processes for server health checks
6096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 yes | no | yes | yes
6098
6099 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6100 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6101 command".
6102
6103 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6104
6105 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6106
6107
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006108option log-health-checks
6109no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006110 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6112 yes | no | yes | yes
6113 Arguments : none
6114
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006115 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6116 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6117 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006118
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006119 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6120 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6121 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6122 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6123 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6124
6125 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6126 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006127
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006128 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6129 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6130 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006131
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006132
6133option log-separate-errors
6134no option log-separate-errors
6135 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | yes | yes | no
6138 Arguments : none
6139
6140 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6141 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6142 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6143 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6144 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6145 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6146 provides very important information.
6147
6148 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6149 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6150 error logs.
6151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006152 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006153 logging.
6154
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006155
6156option logasap
6157no option logasap
6158 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6160 yes | yes | yes | no
6161 Arguments : none
6162
6163 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6164 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6165 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6166 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6167 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6168 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6169 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006170 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006171 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6172 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6173
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006174 Examples :
6175 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6176 mode http
6177 option httplog
6178 option logasap
6179 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6180
6181 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6182 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6183 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6184 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006186 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006187 logging.
6188
6189
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006190option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006191 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006194 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006195 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6196 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006197 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006198
6199 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6200 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6201 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6202 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6203 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6204 in the MySQL table, like this :
6205
6206 USE mysql;
6207 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6208 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6209
6210 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6211 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6212 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6213 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6214 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6215 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6216 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6217 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6218 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6219
6220 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6221 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006222
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006223 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006224
6225 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6226 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6227 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6228 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006229 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6230 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006231
6232 See also: "option httpchk"
6233
6234
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006235option nolinger
6236no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006237 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6239 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006240 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006241
6242 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6243 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6244 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6245 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6246 connections.
6247
6248 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6249 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6250 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6251 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6252 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6253 this too.
6254
6255 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6256 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6257 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6258
6259 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6260 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6261 for servers.
6262
6263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6265
6266
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006267option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6268 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6270 yes | yes | yes | yes
6271 Arguments :
6272 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6273 matching <network>
6274 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6275 header name.
6276
6277 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6278 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6279 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6280 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6281 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6282 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6283 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6284 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6285 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6286 possible that the client has already brought one.
6287
6288 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6289 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6290 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6291 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6292 header and requires different one.
6293
6294 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6295 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6296 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6297 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6298 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6299 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6300 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6301
6302 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6303 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6304 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6305 both are defined.
6306
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006307 Examples :
6308 # Original Destination address
6309 frontend www
6310 mode http
6311 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6312
6313 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6314 backend www
6315 mode http
6316 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6317
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006318 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6319 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006320
6321
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006322option persist
6323no option persist
6324 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6325 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006327 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006328
6329 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6330 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6331 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6332 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6333 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6334 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6335 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6336 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6337 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6338 redirected to another valid server.
6339
6340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6342
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006343 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006344
6345
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006346option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6347 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 yes | no | yes | yes
6350 Arguments :
6351 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6352 PostgreSQL server.
6353
6354 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6355 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6356 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6357 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6358
6359 See also: "option httpchk"
6360
6361
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006362option prefer-last-server
6363no option prefer-last-server
6364 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6366 yes | no | yes | yes
6367 Arguments : none
6368
6369 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6370 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6371 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6372 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6373 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6374 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6375 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6376 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6377 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006378 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6379 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6380 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6381 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6382 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6383 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6384 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006385
6386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6388
6389 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6390
6391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006392option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006393option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006394no option redispatch
6395 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6397 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006398 Arguments :
6399 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6400 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6401 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6402 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6403 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6404 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6405 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6406 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6407 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006409
6410 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6411 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6412 be able to access the service anymore.
6413
6414 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6415 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6416
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006417 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006418 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6419 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006421 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6422 "redisp" keywords.
6423
6424 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6425 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6426
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006427 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006428
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006429
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006430option redis-check
6431 Use redis health checks for server testing
6432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6433 yes | no | yes | yes
6434 Arguments : none
6435
6436 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6437 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6438 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6439 find the "+PONG" response message.
6440
6441 Example :
6442 option redis-check
6443
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006444 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006445
6446
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006447option smtpchk
6448option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6449 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6451 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006452 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006453 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6454 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6455 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6456
6457 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6458 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6459 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6460
6461 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6462 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6463 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6464 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6465 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6466 dead server.
6467
6468 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6469 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6470 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6471 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6472
6473 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6474 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6475 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6476 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006477 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006478
6479 Example :
6480 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6481
6482 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006485option socket-stats
6486no option socket-stats
6487
6488 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 yes | yes | yes | no
6491
6492 Arguments : none
6493
6494
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006495option splice-auto
6496no option splice-auto
6497 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | yes | yes | yes
6500 Arguments : none
6501
6502 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6503 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6504 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6505 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006506 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006507 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6508 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6509 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6510 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6511
6512 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6513 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6514 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6515 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6516 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6517 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6518 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6519 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6520 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6521 keyword.
6522
6523 Example :
6524 option splice-auto
6525
6526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6528
6529 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6530 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6531
6532
6533option splice-request
6534no option splice-request
6535 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | yes
6538 Arguments : none
6539
6540 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006541 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006542 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6543 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6544 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6545 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6546
6547 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6548
6549 Example :
6550 option splice-request
6551
6552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6554
6555 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6556 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6557
6558
6559option splice-response
6560no option splice-response
6561 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6563 yes | yes | yes | yes
6564 Arguments : none
6565
6566 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006567 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006568 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6569 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6570 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6571 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6572
6573 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6574
6575 Example :
6576 option splice-response
6577
6578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6580
6581 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6582 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6583
6584
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006585option spop-check
6586 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6588 no | no | no | yes
6589 Arguments : none
6590
6591 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6592 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6593 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6594 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6595
6596 Example :
6597 option spop-check
6598
6599 See also : "option httpchk"
6600
6601
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006602option srvtcpka
6603no option srvtcpka
6604 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6606 yes | no | yes | yes
6607 Arguments : none
6608
6609 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6610 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6611 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6612 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6613
6614 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6615 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6616 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6617 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6618
6619 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6620 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6621 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6622 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6623 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6624
6625 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6626
6627 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6628 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6629 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6630
6631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6633
6634 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6635
6636
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006637option ssl-hello-chk
6638 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6640 yes | no | yes | yes
6641 Arguments : none
6642
6643 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6644 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6645 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6646 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6647 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6648 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6649 hello message.
6650
6651 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6652 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6653 messages, which is appreciable.
6654
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006655 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6656 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6657 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006658
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006659 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6660
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006661
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006662option tcp-check
6663 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | no | yes | yes
6666
6667 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6668 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6669
6670 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6671 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6672 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6673
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006674 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006675 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6676 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6677 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6678 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6679 only.
6680
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006681 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006682 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6683 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6684 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6685 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6686
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006687 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006688 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6689 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006690 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006691 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6692 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6693 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6694 the respective protocols.
6695 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6696 analysed.
6697
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006698 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6699 script.
6700
6701 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6702 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6703 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6704 The "comment" is of course optional.
6705
6706
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006707 Examples :
6708 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6709 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006710 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006711
6712 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6713 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006714 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006715
6716 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6717 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006718 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006719 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006720 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006721 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006722 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006723 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006724 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6725 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006726 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006727 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6728 tcp-check expect string +OK
6729
6730 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6731 (send many headers before analyzing)
6732 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006733 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006734 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6735 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6736 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6737 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006738 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006739
6740
6741 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6742
6743
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006744option tcp-smart-accept
6745no option tcp-smart-accept
6746 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 yes | yes | yes | no
6749 Arguments : none
6750
6751 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6752 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6753 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6754 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6755 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6756 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6757
6758 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6759 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6760 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6761 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6762
6763 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6764 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6765 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6766 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6767
6768 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6769 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6770 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6771
6772 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6773 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6774 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6775
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006776 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6777
6778
6779option tcp-smart-connect
6780no option tcp-smart-connect
6781 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6783 yes | no | yes | yes
6784 Arguments : none
6785
6786 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6787 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6788 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6789 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6790 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6791
6792 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6793 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6794 complex.
6795
6796 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6797 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6798 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6799
6800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6802
6803 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6804
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006805
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006806option tcpka
6807 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6809 yes | yes | yes | yes
6810 Arguments : none
6811
6812 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6813 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6814 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6815 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6816
6817 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6818 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6819 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6820 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6821
6822 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6823 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6824 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6825 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6826 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6827
6828 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6829
6830 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6831 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6832 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6833 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6834 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6835 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6836 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6837 backends.
6838
6839 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6840
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006841
6842option tcplog
6843 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6845 yes | yes | yes | yes
6846 Arguments : none
6847
6848 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6849 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6850 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6851 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6852 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6853 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6854 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6855 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6856
6857 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6858
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006859 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006861 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006862
6863
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006864option transparent
6865no option transparent
6866 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006868 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006869 Arguments : none
6870
6871 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6872 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6873 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6874 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6875 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6876 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6877 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6878 appropriate server.
6879
6880 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6881 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6882
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006883 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006884 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006885
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006886
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006887external-check command <command>
6888 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6890 yes | no | yes | yes
6891
6892 Arguments :
6893 <command> is the external command to run
6894
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006895 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6896
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006897 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006898
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006899 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6900 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6901 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6902 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6903 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6904 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006905
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006906 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6907
6908 Environment variables :
6909 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6910 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6911
6912 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6913
6914 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6915
6916 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6917 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6918 for a UNIX socket).
6919
6920 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6921
6922 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6923
6924 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6925
6926 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6927
6928 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6929
6930 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6931 socket).
6932
6933 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6934 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6935
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006936 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6937 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6938 failed.
6939
6940 Example :
6941 external-check command /bin/true
6942
6943 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6944
6945
6946external-check path <path>
6947 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | no | yes | yes
6950
6951 Arguments :
6952 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6953
6954 The default path is "".
6955
6956 Example :
6957 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6958
6959 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6960 "external-check command"
6961
6962
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006963persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006964persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006965 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 yes | no | yes | yes
6968 Arguments :
6969 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006970 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6971 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006972
6973 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6974 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6975 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6976 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6977 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6978 forwarded to this server.
6979
6980 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6981 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6982 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006983 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006984 a single "listen" section.
6985
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006986 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6987 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6988 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6989
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006990 Example :
6991 listen tse-farm
6992 bind :3389
6993 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6994 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6995 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6996 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6997 persist rdp-cookie
6998 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006999 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007000 balance rdp-cookie
7001 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7002 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7003
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007004 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7005 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007006
7007
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007008rate-limit sessions <rate>
7009 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7011 yes | yes | yes | no
7012 Arguments :
7013 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7014 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7015
7016 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7017 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7018 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7019 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7020 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7021 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7022
7023 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7024 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7025 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7026 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7027
7028 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7029 listen smtp
7030 mode tcp
7031 bind :25
7032 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007033 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007034
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007035 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7036 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7037 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007038
7039 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7040
7041
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007042redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7043redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7044redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007045 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7047 no | yes | yes | yes
7048
7049 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007050 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007051
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007052 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007053 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007054 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7055 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7056 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007057
7058 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7059 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7060 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7061 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7062 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007063 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7064 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7065 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7066 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007067
7068 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7069 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7070 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7071 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7072 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7073 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007074 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007075 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007076 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7077 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7078 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007079
7080 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007081 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7082 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7083 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007084 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007085 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7086 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7087 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7088 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007089
7090 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7091 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7092
7093 - "drop-query"
7094 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7095 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7096 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7097 with a location-type redirect.
7098
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007099 - "append-slash"
7100 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7101 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7102 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7103 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7104
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007105 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7106 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7107 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7108 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7109 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7110 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7111 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7112
7113 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7114 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7115 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7116 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7117 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7118 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7119 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007120
7121 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7122 acl clear dst_port 80
7123 acl secure dst_port 8080
7124 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007125 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007126 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007127 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7128
7129 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007130 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7131 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7132 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007133 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007134
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007135 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7136 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7137 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7138
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007139 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007140 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007141
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007142 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007143 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7144 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7145 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007147 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007148
7149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007150redisp (deprecated)
7151redispatch (deprecated)
7152 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7153 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7154 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007155 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007156
7157 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7158 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7159 be able to access the service anymore.
7160
7161 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7162 redistribute them to a working server.
7163
7164 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7165 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7166 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007168 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7169 "option redispatch" instead.
7170
7171 See also : "option redispatch"
7172
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007173
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007174reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007175 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 no | yes | yes | yes
7178 Arguments :
7179 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7180 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007181 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007182
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007183 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7184 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7185
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007186 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7187 the last header of an HTTP request.
7188
7189 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7190 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7191 responses.
7192
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007193 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7194 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7195 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7196
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007197 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7198 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007199
7200
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007201reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7202reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007203 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7205 no | yes | yes | yes
7206 Arguments :
7207 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7208 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7209 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7210 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7211 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7212 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7213 ignores case.
7214
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007215 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7216 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7217
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007218 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7219 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7220 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7221 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007222 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007223
7224 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7225 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7226
7227 Example :
7228 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7229 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7230 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7231
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007232 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7233 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007234
7235
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007236reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7237reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007238 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 no | yes | yes | yes
7241 Arguments :
7242 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7243 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7244 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7245 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7246 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7247 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7248
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007249 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7250 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7251
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007252 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7253 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7254 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7255 next servers.
7256
7257 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7258 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7259 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7260
7261 Example :
7262 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7263 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7264 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7265
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007266 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7267 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007268
7269
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007270reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7271reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007272 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7274 no | yes | yes | yes
7275 Arguments :
7276 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7277 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7278 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7279 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7280 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7281 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7282 case.
7283
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007284 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7285 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7286
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007287 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7288 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7289 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7290 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007291 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007292
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007293 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007294 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007295 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007296
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007297 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7298 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7299
7300 Example :
7301 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7302 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7303 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7304
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007305 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7306 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007307
7308
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007309reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7310reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007311 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 no | yes | yes | yes
7314 Arguments :
7315 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7316 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7317 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7318 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7319 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7320 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7321 case.
7322
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007323 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7324 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7325
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007326 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7327 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7328 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7329 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7330
7331 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7332 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7333
7334 Example :
7335 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7336 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7337 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7338 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7339
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007340 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7341 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007342
7343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007344reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7345reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007346 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7348 no | yes | yes | yes
7349 Arguments :
7350 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7351 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7352 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7353 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7354 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7355 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7356
7357 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7358 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7359 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7360 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007361 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007363 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7364 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7365
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007366 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7367 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7368 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7369
7370 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7371 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7372 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7373 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7374 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7375
7376 Example :
7377 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007378 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007379 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7380 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7381
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007382 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7383 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007384
7385
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007386reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7387reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007388 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 no | yes | yes | yes
7391 Arguments :
7392 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7393 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7394 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7395 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7396 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7397 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7398 ignores case.
7399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007400 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7401 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7402
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007403 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7404 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007405 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7406 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7407 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007408 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7409 not set.
7410
7411 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7412 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7413 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7414 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7415 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7416
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007417 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007418 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7419 # block all others.
7420 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7421 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007423 # block bad guys
7424 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7425 reqitarpit . if badguys
7426
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007427 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7428 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007429
7430
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007431retries <value>
7432 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7434 yes | no | yes | yes
7435 Arguments :
7436 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7437 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7438 default value is 3.
7439
7440 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7441 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7442 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7443
7444 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007445 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7446 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007447
7448 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7449 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7450
7451 See also : "option redispatch"
7452
7453
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007454rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007455 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7457 no | yes | yes | yes
7458 Arguments :
7459 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7460 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007461 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007462
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007463 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7464 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7465
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007466 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7467 the last header of an HTTP response.
7468
7469 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7470 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7471 responses.
7472
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007473 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7474 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007475
7476
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007477rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7478rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007479 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7481 no | yes | yes | yes
7482 Arguments :
7483 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7484 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7485 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7486 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7487 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7488 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7489 ignores case.
7490
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007491 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7492 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007494 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7495 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007496 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007497 client.
7498
7499 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7500 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7501 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7502
7503 Example :
7504 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007505 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007506
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007507 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7508 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007509
7510
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007511rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7512rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007513 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 no | yes | yes | yes
7516 Arguments :
7517 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7518 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7519 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7520 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7521 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7522 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7523 ignores case.
7524
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007525 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7526 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7527
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007528 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7529 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7530 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7531 case-sensitive.
7532
7533 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007534 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7535 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7536 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007537
7538 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7539 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7540
7541 Example :
7542 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7543 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7544
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007545 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7546 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007547
7548
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007549rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7550rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007551 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7553 no | yes | yes | yes
7554 Arguments :
7555 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7556 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7557 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7558 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7559 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7560 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7561 ignores case.
7562
7563 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7564 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7565 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7566 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007567 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007568
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007569 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7570 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7571
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007572 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7573 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7574 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7575
7576 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7577 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7578 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7579 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7580 are not case-sensitive.
7581
7582 Example :
7583 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7584 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7585
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007586 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7587 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007588
7589
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007590server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007591 Declare a server in a backend
7592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7593 no | no | yes | yes
7594 Arguments :
7595 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007596 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007597 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007598
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007599 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7600 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7601 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7602 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007603 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7604 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7605 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7606 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7607 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007608 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7609 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7610 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7611 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7612 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7613 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7614 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007615 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007616 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7617 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007618 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7619 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007621 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007622 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7623 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7624 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7625 adding this value to the client's port.
7626
7627 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7628 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007629 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007630
7631 Examples :
7632 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7633 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007634 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007635 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7636 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7637 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007638
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007639 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7640 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7641 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7642 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7643 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7644
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007645 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7646 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007647
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007648server-state-file-name [<file>]
7649 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7650 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7651 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7652 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7653 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7654 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7655
7656 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7657 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7658
7659 global
7660 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7661
7662 backend bk
7663 load-server-state-from-file
7664
7665 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7666 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007667
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007668server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7669 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7670 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 no | no | yes | yes
7673
7674 Arguments:
7675 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7676
7677 <num | range>
7678 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7679 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7680 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7681 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7682
7683 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7684
7685 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7686
7687 <params*>
7688 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7689 keyword.
7690
7691 Examples:
7692 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7693 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7694 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7695
7696 # or
7697 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7698
7699 # would be equivalent to:
7700 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7701 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7702 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7703
7704
7705
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007706source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007707source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007708source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007709 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7711 yes | no | yes | yes
7712 Arguments :
7713 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7714 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007715
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007716 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007717 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7718 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7719 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7720 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7721 supported prefixes are :
7722 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7723 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7724 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007725 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007726 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7727 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007728
7729 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7730 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007731 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7732 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7733 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007734
7735 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7736 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7737 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7738 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7739 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7740 <addr>.
7741
7742 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7743 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7744 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7745 port.
7746
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007747 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7748 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7749 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7750 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007751 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007752 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7753 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7754 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7755 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7756 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7757 HTTP header.
7758
7759 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7760 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007761 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007762 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7763 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7764 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7765 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7766 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7767 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7768 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7769
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007770 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7771 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7772 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7773 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7774 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7775 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7776
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007777 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7778 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7779 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7780 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7781
7782 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7783 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7784 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7785 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7786 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7787 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7788
7789 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7790 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7791 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7792 there are two methods :
7793
7794 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7795 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7796 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7797 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7798 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7799 of the client ranges may be used.
7800
7801 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7802 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7803 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7804 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7805 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7806 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7807 same session.
7808
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007809 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7810 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7811 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007812 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007813
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007814 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7815
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007816 Examples :
7817 backend private
7818 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7819 source 192.168.1.200
7820
7821 backend transparent_ssl1
7822 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7823 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7824
7825 backend transparent_ssl2
7826 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7827 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7828 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7829
7830 backend transparent_ssl3
7831 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7832 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7833 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7834
7835 backend transparent_smtp
7836 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7837 # with Tproxy version 4.
7838 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7839
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007840 backend transparent_http
7841 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7842 # proxy.
7843 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007845 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007846 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007848
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007849srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7850 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 yes | no | yes | yes
7853 Arguments :
7854 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7856 as explained at the top of this document.
7857
7858 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7859 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7860 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7861 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7862 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7863 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7864 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7865
7866 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7867 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7868 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7869 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7870 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007871 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007872 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007873 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007874
7875 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7876 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7877 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7878 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7879 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7880 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7881
7882 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7883 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7884
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007885 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7886 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007887
7888
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007889stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7890 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007892 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007893
7894 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7895 matched.
7896
7897 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7898 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7899
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007900 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7901 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7902 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7903
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007904 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7905 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7906 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7907 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007908
7909 Example :
7910 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7911 backend stats_localhost
7912 stats enable
7913 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7914
7915 Example :
7916 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7917 backend stats_auth
7918 stats enable
7919 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7920 stats admin if TRUE
7921
7922 Example :
7923 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7924 userlist stats-auth
7925 group admin users admin
7926 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7927 group readonly users haproxy
7928 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7929
7930 backend stats_auth
7931 stats enable
7932 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7933 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7934 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7935 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7936
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007937 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7938 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7939 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007940
7941
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007942stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7943 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007945 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007946 Arguments :
7947 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7948
7949 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7950
7951 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7952 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7953 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7954 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7955 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7956 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7957
7958 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7959 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7960 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007961 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007962
7963 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7964 report using "stats scope".
7965
7966 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7967 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7968 unobvious parameters.
7969
7970 Example :
7971 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7972 backend public_www
7973 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7974 stats enable
7975 stats hide-version
7976 stats scope .
7977 stats uri /admin?stats
7978 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7979 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7980 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7981
7982 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7983 backend private_monitoring
7984 stats enable
7985 stats uri /admin?stats
7986 stats refresh 5s
7987
7988 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7989
7990
7991stats enable
7992 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007994 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007995 Arguments : none
7996
7997 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7998 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7999 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8000 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8001 - stats auth : no authentication
8002 - stats scope : no restriction
8003
8004 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8005 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8006 unobvious parameters.
8007
8008 Example :
8009 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8010 backend public_www
8011 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8012 stats enable
8013 stats hide-version
8014 stats scope .
8015 stats uri /admin?stats
8016 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8017 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8018 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8019
8020 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8021 backend private_monitoring
8022 stats enable
8023 stats uri /admin?stats
8024 stats refresh 5s
8025
8026 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8027
8028
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008029stats hide-version
8030 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008032 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008033 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008034
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008035 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8036 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8037 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8038 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8039 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8040 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008042 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8043 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8044 unobvious parameters.
8045
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008046 Example :
8047 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8048 backend public_www
8049 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008050 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008051 stats hide-version
8052 stats scope .
8053 stats uri /admin?stats
8054 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8055 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8056 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008057
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008058 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8059 backend private_monitoring
8060 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008061 stats uri /admin?stats
8062 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008063
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008064 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008065
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008066
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008067stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8068 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8069 Access control for statistics
8070
8071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8072 no | no | yes | yes
8073
8074 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8075 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8076 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8077 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8078 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8079 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8080
8081 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8082 instance.
8083
8084 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8085 about ACL usage.
8086
8087
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008088stats realm <realm>
8089 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008091 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008092 Arguments :
8093 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8094 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8095 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8096
8097 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8098 using a backslash ('\').
8099
8100 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8101 only related to authentication.
8102
8103 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8104 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8105 unobvious parameters.
8106
8107 Example :
8108 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8109 backend public_www
8110 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8111 stats enable
8112 stats hide-version
8113 stats scope .
8114 stats uri /admin?stats
8115 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8116 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8117 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8118
8119 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8120 backend private_monitoring
8121 stats enable
8122 stats uri /admin?stats
8123 stats refresh 5s
8124
8125 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8126
8127
8128stats refresh <delay>
8129 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008131 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008132 Arguments :
8133 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8134 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8135 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8136 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8137 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8138 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8139
8140 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8141 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8142 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8143 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8144
8145 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8146 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8147 unobvious parameters.
8148
8149 Example :
8150 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8151 backend public_www
8152 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8153 stats enable
8154 stats hide-version
8155 stats scope .
8156 stats uri /admin?stats
8157 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8158 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8159 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8160
8161 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8162 backend private_monitoring
8163 stats enable
8164 stats uri /admin?stats
8165 stats refresh 5s
8166
8167 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8168
8169
8170stats scope { <name> | "." }
8171 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008173 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008174 Arguments :
8175 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8176 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8177 section in which the statement appears.
8178
8179 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8180 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8181 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8182 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8183 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8184 exists.
8185
8186 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8187 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8188 unobvious parameters.
8189
8190 Example :
8191 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8192 backend public_www
8193 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8194 stats enable
8195 stats hide-version
8196 stats scope .
8197 stats uri /admin?stats
8198 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8199 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8200 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8201
8202 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8203 backend private_monitoring
8204 stats enable
8205 stats uri /admin?stats
8206 stats refresh 5s
8207
8208 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8209
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008210
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008211stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008212 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008214 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008215
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008216 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008217 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8218
8219 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8220 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8221
8222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008224 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008225
8226 Example :
8227 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8228 backend private_monitoring
8229 stats enable
8230 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8231 stats uri /admin?stats
8232 stats refresh 5s
8233
8234 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8235 global section.
8236
8237
8238stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008239 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8241 yes | yes | yes | yes
8242 Arguments : none
8243
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008244 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008245 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8246 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8247 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8248 - IP (socket, server)
8249 - cookie (backend, server)
8250
8251 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8252 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008253 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008254
8255 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8256
8257
8258stats show-node [ <name> ]
8259 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008262 Arguments:
8263 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8264 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8265
8266 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8267 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008268 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008269
8270 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8271 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8272 unobvious parameters.
8273
8274 Example:
8275 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8276 backend private_monitoring
8277 stats enable
8278 stats show-node Europe-1
8279 stats uri /admin?stats
8280 stats refresh 5s
8281
8282 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8283 section.
8284
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008285
8286stats uri <prefix>
8287 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008289 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008290 Arguments :
8291 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8292 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8293 query string.
8294
8295 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8296 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8297 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8298 possible to reach it in the application.
8299
8300 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008301 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008302 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8303 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8304 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8305 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8306
8307 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8308 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8309 an address or a port to statistics only.
8310
8311 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8312 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8313 unobvious parameters.
8314
8315 Example :
8316 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8317 backend public_www
8318 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8319 stats enable
8320 stats hide-version
8321 stats scope .
8322 stats uri /admin?stats
8323 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8324 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8325 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8326
8327 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8328 backend private_monitoring
8329 stats enable
8330 stats uri /admin?stats
8331 stats refresh 5s
8332
8333 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8334
8335
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008336stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8337 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008339 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008340
8341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008342 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008343 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8344 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8345 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8346
8347 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8348 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8349 the "stick-table" statement.
8350
8351 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8352 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8353 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8354 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8355 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8356
8357 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8358 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8359 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8360 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8361 transformation rules.
8362
8363 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8364 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8365 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8366 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8367 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8368 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8369 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8370
8371 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8372 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8373 ACL based conditions.
8374
8375 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8376 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8377 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8378 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8379
8380 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8381 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8382 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8383 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8384
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008385 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8386 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8387 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8388
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008389 Example :
8390 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8391 # last 30 minutes
8392 backend pop
8393 mode tcp
8394 balance roundrobin
8395 stick store-request src
8396 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8397 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8398 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8399
8400 backend smtp
8401 mode tcp
8402 balance roundrobin
8403 stick match src table pop
8404 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8405 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8406
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008407 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008408 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008409
8410
8411stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8412 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 no | no | yes | yes
8415
8416 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8417 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8418 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8419 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8420
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008421 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8422 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8423 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8424
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008425 Examples :
8426 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008427 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008428
8429 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8430 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8431 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8432
8433
8434 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8435 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8436 backend http
8437 mode http
8438 balance roundrobin
8439 stick on src table https
8440 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8441 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8442 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8443
8444 backend https
8445 mode tcp
8446 balance roundrobin
8447 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8448 stick on src
8449 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8450 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8451
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008452 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008453
8454
8455stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8456 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8458 no | no | yes | yes
8459
8460 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008461 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008462 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8463 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8464 server is selected.
8465
8466 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8467 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8468 the "stick-table" statement.
8469
8470 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8471 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8472 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8473 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8474 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8475 address.
8476
8477 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8478 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8479 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8480 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8481 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8482 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8483 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8484 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8485 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8486 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8487
8488 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8489 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8490 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8491 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8492 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8493 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8494 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8495
8496 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8497 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8498 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8499 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8500
8501 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8502 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8503 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8504 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8505 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8506 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008507 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8508 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8509 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8510 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8511 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8512 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008513
8514 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8515 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8516 the request.
8517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008518 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8519 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8520 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8521
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008522 Example :
8523 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8524 # last 30 minutes
8525 backend pop
8526 mode tcp
8527 balance roundrobin
8528 stick store-request src
8529 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8530 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8531 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8532
8533 backend smtp
8534 mode tcp
8535 balance roundrobin
8536 stick match src table pop
8537 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8538 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8539
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008540 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008541 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008542
8543
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008544stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008545 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8546 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008547 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008549 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008550
8551 Arguments :
8552 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8553 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8554 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8555 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8556
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008557 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8558 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8559 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8560 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8561
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008562 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8563 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8564 instance.
8565
8566 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8567 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8568 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8569 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8570 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8571 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008572 to 32 characters.
8573
8574 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8575 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8576 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008577 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008578 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8579 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008580
8581 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008582 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8583 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008584 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8585 increase.
8586
8587 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008588 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8589 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8590 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008591
8592 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8593 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8594 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8595 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8596 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8597 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8598 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8599 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8600 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8601 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8602 parameter (see below).
8603
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008604 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8605 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8606 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8607 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8608 soft restart.
8609
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008610 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8611 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008612
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008613 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8614 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8615 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8616 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008617 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008618 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008619 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8620 if not expiration delay is specified.
8621
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008622 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8623 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8624 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8625 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008626 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8627 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8628 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8629 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8630 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8631 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8632 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8633 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8634 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8635 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8636 types and their arguments.
8637
8638 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8639 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8640 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8641 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8642
8643 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8644 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8645 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8646 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8647
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008648 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8649 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8650 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8651 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8652 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8653 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8654
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008655 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8656 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8657 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8658 they were received.
8659
8660 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8661 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8662 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8663 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8664 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8665
8666 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8667 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8668 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8669 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8670 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8671
8672 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8673 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8674 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8675
8676 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8677 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8678 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8679 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8680 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8681
8682 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8683 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8684 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8685 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8686 the client side.
8687
8688 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8689 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8690 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8691 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8692 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8693 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8694 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8695
8696 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8697 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8698 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8699 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8700 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8701 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8702 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8703
8704 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8705 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8706 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8707 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8708 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8709 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8710
8711 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8712 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8713 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8714 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8715
8716 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8717 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8718 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8719 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8720 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8721 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8722 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8723 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8724 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8725 recommended for better fairness.
8726
8727 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8728 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8729 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8730 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8731
8732 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8733 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8734 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8735 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8736 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8737 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8738 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8739 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8740 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8741 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008742
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008743 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8744 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008745 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8746 reference it.
8747
8748 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8749 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008750 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8751 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8752 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008753
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008754 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8755 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8756 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8757 something that can be ignored.
8758
8759 Example:
8760 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8761 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8762 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8763 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8764
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008765 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008766 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008767
8768
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008769stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008770 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8772 no | no | yes | yes
8773
8774 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008775 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008776 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8777 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8778 server is selected.
8779
8780 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8781 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8782 the "stick-table" statement.
8783
8784 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8785 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8786 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8787 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8788
8789 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8790 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8791 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8792 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8793 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8794 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008795 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008796 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8797 rules.
8798
8799 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8800 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8801 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8802 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8803 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8804 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8805 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8806
8807 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8808 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8809 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8810 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8811
8812 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8813 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8814 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8815 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8816 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8817 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008818 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8819 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8820 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8821 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8822 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8823 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8824 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8825 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8826 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008827
8828 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8829
8830 Example :
8831 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8832 backend https
8833 mode tcp
8834 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008835 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008836 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008837
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008838 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8839 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8840
8841 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8842 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8843 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8844
8845 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8846 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008847
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008848 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8849 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8850 # at offset 44.
8851
8852 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8853 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8854
8855 # Learn on response if server hello.
8856 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008857
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008858 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8859 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8860
8861 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8862 extraction.
8863
8864
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008865tcp-check connect [params*]
8866 Opens a new connection
8867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8868 no | no | yes | yes
8869
8870 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8871 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8872 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8873
8874 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8875 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8876 of the sequence.
8877
8878 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8879 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8880 do.
8881
8882 Parameters :
8883 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8884 use the TCP connection.
8885
8886 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8887 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8888 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8889
8890 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8891
8892 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8893
8894 Examples:
8895 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8896 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8897 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8898 option tcp-check
8899 tcp-check connect
8900 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8901 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8902 tcp-check send \r\n
8903 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8904 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8905 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8906 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8907 tcp-check send \r\n
8908 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8909 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8910
8911 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8912 option tcp-check
8913 tcp-check connect port 110
8914 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8915 tcp-check connect port 143
8916 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8917 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8918
8919 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8920
8921
8922tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8923 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8925 no | no | yes | yes
8926
8927 Arguments :
8928 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8929 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8930 binary.
8931 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8932 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8933 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8934
8935 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8936 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8937 with the usual backslash ('\').
8938 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8939 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8940 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8941 used upper or lower case.
8942
8943
8944 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8945
8946 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8947 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8948 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8949 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8950 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8951 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8952 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8953 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8954
8955 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8956 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8957 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8958 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8959 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8960 expression.
8961
8962 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8963 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8964 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8965 this exact hexadecimal string.
8966 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8967
8968 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8969 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8970 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8971 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8972 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8973 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8974 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8975 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8976 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8977 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8978 the null character.
8979
8980 Examples :
8981 # perform a POP check
8982 option tcp-check
8983 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8984
8985 # perform an IMAP check
8986 option tcp-check
8987 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8988
8989 # look for the redis master server
8990 option tcp-check
8991 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008992 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008993 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8994 tcp-check expect string role:master
8995 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8996 tcp-check expect string +OK
8997
8998
8999 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9000 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9001
9002
9003tcp-check send <data>
9004 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9006 no | no | yes | yes
9007
9008 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9009 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9010
9011 Examples :
9012 # look for the redis master server
9013 option tcp-check
9014 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9015 tcp-check expect string role:master
9016
9017 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9018 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9019
9020
9021tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
9022 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
9023 tcp health check
9024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9025 no | no | yes | yes
9026
9027 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9028 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9029 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
9030 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9031 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9032 hexadecimal string.
9033 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9034
9035 Examples :
9036 # redis check in binary
9037 option tcp-check
9038 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9039 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9040
9041
9042 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9043 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9044
9045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009046tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9047 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9049 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009050 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009051 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9052 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009054 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009055
9056 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9057 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009058 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9059 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9060 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9061 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9062 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9063 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009065 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9066 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9067 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9068 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009069
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009070 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009071 - accept :
9072 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9073 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9074 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009076 - reject :
9077 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9078 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9079 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9080 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9081 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9082 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9083 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9084 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9085 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9086 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9087 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009088 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009089
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009090 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9091 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9092 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9093 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9094 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9095 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9096 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9097 hosts.
9098
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009099 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9100 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9101 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9102 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9103 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9104 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9105 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9106 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9107
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009108 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9109 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9110 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9111 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9112 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9113 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9114 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9115 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9116 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009117 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9118 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009119
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009120 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009121 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009122 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009123 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009124 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9125 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009126 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009127 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9128 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9129 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9130 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9131 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009134 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009135 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009136 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9137 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9138 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9139 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009141 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9142 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9143 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9144 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009146 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9147 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9148 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9149 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9150 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009151 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9152 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9153 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9154 layer7 information is extracted.
9155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009156 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9157 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9158 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9159 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9160 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009161
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009162 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9163 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9164 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9165 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9166
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009167 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9168 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9169 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9170 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9171 continues.
9172
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009173 - set-src <expr> :
9174 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9175 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9176 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9177 set-src"
9178
9179 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9180 followed by some converters.
9181
9182 Example:
9183
9184 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9185
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009186 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9187 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009188
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009189 - set-src-port <expr> :
9190 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9191 expression.
9192
9193 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9194 followed by some converters.
9195
9196 Example:
9197
9198 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9199
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009200 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9201 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9202 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009203
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009204 - set-dst <expr> :
9205 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9206 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9207 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9208 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9209 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9210
9211 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9212 followed by some converters.
9213
9214 Example:
9215
9216 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9217 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9218
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009219 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9220 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9221
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009222 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9223 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9224 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9225 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9226
9227
9228 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9229 followed by some converters.
9230
9231 Example:
9232
9233 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9234
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009235 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9236 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9237 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9238
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009239 - "silent-drop" :
9240 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9241 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9242 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9243 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9244 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9245 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9246 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9247 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9248 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9249 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9250 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9251 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9252 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9253 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9254 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9255 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009257 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9258 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9259 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009261 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9262 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9263 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009265 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009266 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009267 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009269 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9270 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9271 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009273 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009274 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9275 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009276
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009277 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9278
9279 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9280
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009281 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9282
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009283 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009284
9285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009286tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9287 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009289 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009290 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009291 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9292 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009294 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009296 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9297 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9298 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9299 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9300 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009302 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9303 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9304 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9305 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009306 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9307 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9308 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9309 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9310 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9311 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009312 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009313 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009315 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9316 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9317 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9318 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009319
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009320 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009321 - accept : the request is accepted
9322 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9323 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009324 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009325 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009326 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009327 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009328 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009329 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009330 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009332 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9333 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009334
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009335 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9336 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9337 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9338 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9339 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9340 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009342 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009343 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9344 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009345
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009346 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009347 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9348 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9349 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9350 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009351 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9352 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9353 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009354
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009355 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009356 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9357 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9358 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009359
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009360 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009361 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9362 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009363
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009364 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9365 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009369 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009371 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9373 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009375 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9376 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009377
9378 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9379 followed by some converters.
9380
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009381 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9382 <var-name>.
9383
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009384 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9385 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9386 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9387 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9388 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9389
9390 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9391
9392 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9393
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009394 Example:
9395
9396 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009397 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009398
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009399 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009400 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9401 # and reject everything else.
9402 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9403 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009404 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009405 tcp-request content reject
9406
9407 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009408 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9409 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9410 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009411 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009412
9413 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9414 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9415 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009416 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009417 tcp-request content reject
9418
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009419 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009420 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009421 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009422 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009423 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9424 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009425
9426 Example:
9427 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9428 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009429 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009431 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009432 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009433
9434 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009435 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009436 # protecting all our sites
9437 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009438 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9439 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009440 ...
9441 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9442
9443 backend http_dynamic
9444 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009445 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009446 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009447 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009448 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009449 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009450 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009452 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009453
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009454 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9455 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009456
9457
9458tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9459 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009461 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009462 Arguments :
9463 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9464 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9465 as explained at the top of this document.
9466
9467 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9468 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9469 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9470 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9471 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9472
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009473 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9474 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9475 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9476 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9477
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009478 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9479 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009480 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009481 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009482 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9483 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9484 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9485 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009486
9487 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9488 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9489 it pass through unaffected.
9490
9491 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9492 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9493 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009494 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009495 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9496 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009497 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9498 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9499 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009500
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009501 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009502 "timeout client".
9503
9504
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009505tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9506 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9508 no | no | yes | yes
9509 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009510 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9511 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009512
9513 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9514
9515 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9516 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9517 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009518 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9519 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009520
9521 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9522
9523 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9524 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9525 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9526 inserted.
9527
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009528 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009529 - accept :
9530 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9531 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9532 the rules evaluation.
9533
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009534 - close :
9535 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9536 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9537 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9538 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9539 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9540 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009541 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009542 protocols.
9543
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009544 - reject :
9545 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9546 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009547 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009548
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009549 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9550 Sets a variable.
9551
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009552 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9553 Unsets a variable.
9554
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009555 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9556 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9557 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9558 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9559
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009560 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9561 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9562 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9563 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9564 continues.
9565
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009566 - "silent-drop" :
9567 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9568 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9569 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9570 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9571 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9572 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9573 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9574 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9575 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9576 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9577 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9578 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9579 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9580 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9581 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9582 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9583
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009584 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9585 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9586
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009587 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9588 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9589 for changing the default action to a reject.
9590
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009591 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9592 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9593 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9594 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009595 period.
9596
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009597 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9598 declared inline.
9599
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009600 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9601 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009602 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009603 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9604 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009605 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009606 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009607 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009608 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9609 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009610 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009611 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9612 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009613
9614 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9615 followed by some converters.
9616
9617 Example:
9618
9619 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9620
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009621 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9622 <var-name>.
9623
9624 Example:
9625
9626 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9627
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009628 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9629 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9630 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9631 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9632 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9633
9634 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9635
9636 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9637
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009638 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9639
9640 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9641
9642
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009643tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9644 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9646 no | yes | yes | no
9647 Arguments :
9648 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9649 below.
9650
9651 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9652
9653 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9654 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9655 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9656 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9657 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9658 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9659 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9660 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9661 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9662 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9663 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9664 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9665 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9666 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9667 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9668 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9669 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9670 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9671 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9672 instead.
9673
9674 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9675 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9676 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9677 rules which may be inserted.
9678
9679 Several types of actions are supported :
9680 - accept : the request is accepted
9681 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9682 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9683 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9684 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9685 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009686 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009687 - silent-drop
9688
9689 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9690 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9691 sections for a complete description.
9692
9693 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9694 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9695 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9696
9697 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9698 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9699 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9700 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9701 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9702
9703 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9704 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9705
9706 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9707 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9708 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9709
9710 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9711 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9712 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9713
9714 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9715 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9716 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9717
9718 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9719 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9720 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9721
9722 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9723
9724 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9725
9726
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009727tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9728 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9730 no | no | yes | yes
9731 Arguments :
9732 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9734 as explained at the top of this document.
9735
9736 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9737
9738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009739timeout check <timeout>
9740 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9741 established.
9742
9743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9744 yes | no | yes | yes
9745 Arguments:
9746 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9747 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9748 as explained at the top of this document.
9749
9750 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9751 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9752 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9753 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009754 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9755 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9756 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009757
9758 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9759 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9760
9761 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9762 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009763 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009764
9765 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9766 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9767 forget about it.
9768
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009769 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9770 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009771
9772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009773timeout client <timeout>
9774timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9775 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9777 yes | yes | yes | no
9778 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009779 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009780 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9781 as explained at the top of this document.
9782
9783 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9784 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9785 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009786 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9787 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9788 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9789 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009790 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9791 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9792 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009793 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009794 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009795 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9796 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009797 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9798 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009799
9800 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9801 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9802 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9803 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9804 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9805 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9806
9807 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9808 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9809 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9810
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009811 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9812 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009813
9814
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009815timeout client-fin <timeout>
9816 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9818 yes | yes | yes | no
9819 Arguments :
9820 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9821 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9822 as explained at the top of this document.
9823
9824 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9825 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9826 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9827 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9828 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9829 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9830 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009831 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9832 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9833 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009834
9835 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9836 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9837 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9838
9839 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9840
9841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009842timeout connect <timeout>
9843timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9844 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9846 yes | no | yes | yes
9847 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009848 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009849 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9850 as explained at the top of this document.
9851
9852 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009853 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009854 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009855 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009856 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9857 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009858
9859 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9860 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9861 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9862 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9863 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9864 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9865
9866 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9867 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9868 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9869
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009870 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9871 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009872
9873
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009874timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9875 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9877 yes | yes | yes | yes
9878 Arguments :
9879 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9880 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9881 as explained at the top of this document.
9882
9883 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9884 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9885 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9886 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9887 once the request has started to present itself.
9888
9889 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9890 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9891 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9892 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9893 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9894
9895 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9896 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9897 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9898 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9899
9900 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9901 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9902 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9903 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9904 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009905 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009906
9907 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9908 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9909 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9910 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9911
9912 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9913
9914
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009915timeout http-request <timeout>
9916 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009918 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009919 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9922 as explained at the top of this document.
9923
9924 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9925 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9926 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9927 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9928 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9929 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9930 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009931 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9932 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9933 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9934 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9935 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009936 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9937 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009938
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009939 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9940 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9941 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9942 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9943 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009944 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009945
9946 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9947 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9948 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9949 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9950 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9951
9952 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009953 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9954 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9955 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009956
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009957 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009958 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009959
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009960
9961timeout queue <timeout>
9962 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9964 yes | no | yes | yes
9965 Arguments :
9966 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9967 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9968 as explained at the top of this document.
9969
9970 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9971 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9972 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9973 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9974 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9975
9976 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9977 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9978 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9979 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9980
9981 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9982
9983
9984timeout server <timeout>
9985timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9986 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9988 yes | no | yes | yes
9989 Arguments :
9990 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9991 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9992 as explained at the top of this document.
9993
9994 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9995 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9996 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9997 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9998 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9999 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10000 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10001
10002 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10003 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10004 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10005 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10006 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010007 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010008 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010009 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10010 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
10011 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10012 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010013
10014 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10015 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10016 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10017 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10018 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10019 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10020
10021 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10022 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10023 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10024
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010025 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010026
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010027
10028timeout server-fin <timeout>
10029 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10031 yes | no | yes | yes
10032 Arguments :
10033 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10034 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10035 as explained at the top of this document.
10036
10037 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10038 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10039 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10040 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10041 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10042 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10043 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10044 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10045 situations, it should not be needed.
10046
10047 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10048 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10049 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10050
10051 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10052
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010053
10054timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010055 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10057 yes | yes | yes | yes
10058 Arguments :
10059 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10060 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10061 as explained at the top of this document.
10062
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010063 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10064 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10065 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10066 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010067
10068 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10069 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10070 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10071 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010072 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010073
10074 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10075
10076
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010077timeout tunnel <timeout>
10078 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10080 yes | no | yes | yes
10081 Arguments :
10082 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10083 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10084 as explained at the top of this document.
10085
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010086 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010087 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10088 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10089 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10090 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10091 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10092 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10093 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10094 specified.
10095
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010096 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10097 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10098 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10099 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10100 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10101 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10102 state.
10103
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010104 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10105 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10106 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10107 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10108 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10109
10110 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10111 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10112 forget about it.
10113
10114 Example :
10115 defaults http
10116 option http-server-close
10117 timeout connect 5s
10118 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010119 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010120 timeout server 30s
10121 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10122
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010123 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010124
10125
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010126transparent (deprecated)
10127 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010129 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010130 Arguments : none
10131
10132 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10133 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10134 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10135 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10136 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10137 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10138 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10139 appropriate server.
10140
10141 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10142
10143 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10144 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10145
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010146 See also: "option transparent"
10147
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010148unique-id-format <string>
10149 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10151 yes | yes | yes | no
10152 Arguments :
10153 <string> is a log-format string.
10154
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010155 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10156 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10157 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10158 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010159
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010160 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10161 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10162 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10163 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10164 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10165 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10166 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10167 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010168
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010169 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10170 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010171
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010172 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010173
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010174 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010175
10176 will generate:
10177
10178 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10179
10180 See also: "unique-id-header"
10181
10182unique-id-header <name>
10183 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10185 yes | yes | yes | no
10186 Arguments :
10187 <name> is the name of the header.
10188
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010189 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10190 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010191
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010192 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010193
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010194 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010195 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10196
10197 will generate:
10198
10199 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10200
10201 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010202
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010203use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010204 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10206 no | yes | yes | no
10207 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010208 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10209 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010210
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010211 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10212 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010213
10214 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10215 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10216 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010217 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10218 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10219 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10220 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010221
10222 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10223 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10224 assign the backend.
10225
10226 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10227 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10228 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10229 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10230 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10231 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10232
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010233 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010234 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010235 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10236 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10237 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10238
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010239 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10240 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10241 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10242 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10243 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10244 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10245 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10246 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10247 cannot be forced from the request.
10248
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010249 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010250 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10251 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10252
10253 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10254 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010255
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010256
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010257use-server <server> if <condition>
10258use-server <server> unless <condition>
10259 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10261 no | no | yes | yes
10262 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010263 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010264
10265 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10266
10267 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10268 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10269 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10270
10271 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10272 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10273 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10274 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10275 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10276 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10277 matches will assign the server.
10278
10279 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10280 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10281 with the next rules until one matches.
10282
10283 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10284 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10285 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10286 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10287
10288 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10289 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10290 stripped.
10291
10292 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10293 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10294 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10295 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10296
10297 Example :
10298 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10299 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10300 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10301 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10302 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10303 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010304 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010305 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10306 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010308 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010310
103115. Bind and Server options
10312--------------------------
10313
10314The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10315depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10316settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10317written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10318described in this section.
10319
10320
103215.1. Bind options
10322-----------------
10323
10324The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10325as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10326no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10327parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10328while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10329provided immediately after the setting name.
10330
10331The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10332
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010333accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10334 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10335 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10336 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10337 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10338 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10339 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10340 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10341 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10342 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010343 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10344 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10345 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010347accept-proxy
10348 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010349 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10350 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010351 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10352 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10353 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10354 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10355 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10356 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10357 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010358 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10359 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010360
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010361allow-0rtt
10362 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10363 due to security considerations.
10364
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010365alpn <protocols>
10366 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10367 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10368 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10369 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10370 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10371 initial NPN extension.
10372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010373backlog <backlog>
10374 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10375 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10376
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010377curves <curves>
10378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10379 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10380 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10381 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10382 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10383 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10384
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010385ecdhe <named curve>
10386 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010387 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10388 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010389
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010390ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10392 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10393 client's certificate.
10394
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010395ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10397 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10398 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10399 error is ignored.
10400
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010401ca-sign-file <cafile>
10402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10403 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10404 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10405 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10406 'generate-certificates' for details.
10407
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010408ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10410 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10411 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10412 'generate-certificates' for details.
10413
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010414ciphers <ciphers>
10415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10416 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010417 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010418 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10419 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010420 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10421 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10422 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10423 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010424
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010425crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10427 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10428 to verify client's certificate.
10429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010430crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010431 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10432 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10433 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10434 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10435 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10436 file.
10437
10438 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10439 are loaded.
10440
10441 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010442 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010443 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10444 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10445 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10446 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10447 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10448 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10449 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010450
10451 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10452 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10453 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10454 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010455 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10456 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010457
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010458 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010459
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010460 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10461 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010462 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010463 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10464 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10465 clients).
10466
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010467 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10468 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10469 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10470 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10471 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10472 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10473 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10474 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10475 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10476 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10477 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10478 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10479 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10480
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010481 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10482 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10483 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10484 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10485 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10486
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010487 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10488 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10489 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10490 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010491
10492 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10493 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10494 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10495 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10496 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10497 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10498 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10499 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10500 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10501
10502 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10503
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010504 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010505 a cert bundle.
10506
10507 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10508 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10509 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10510 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10511 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10512 provide multi-cert support.
10513
10514 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10515
10516 Filename | CN | SAN
10517 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10518 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010519 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010520 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10521 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10522
10523 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10524 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10525 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10526 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010527 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10528 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10529 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010530
10531 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10532 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10533
10534 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10535 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10536 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10537
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010538crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10540 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010541 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010542 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010543
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010544crt-list <file>
10545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010546 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10547 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010548
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010549 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10550
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010551 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10552 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010553 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010554 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010555
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010556 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10557 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10558 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10559 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10560 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10561 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10562 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10563 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010564
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010565 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010566 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010567 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10568 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10569 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010570
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010571 crt-list file example:
10572 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010573 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010574 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010575 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010576
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010577defer-accept
10578 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10579 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10580 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10581 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10582 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10583 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10584 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10585 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10586 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10587 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10588 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10589
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010590expose-fd listeners
10591 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10592 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010593 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10594 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010595 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10596
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010597force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010598 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010599 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010600 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010601 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010602
10603force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010604 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010605 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010606 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010607
10608force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010609 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010610 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010611 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010612
10613force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010614 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010615 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010616 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010617
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010618force-tlsv13
10619 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10620 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010621 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010622
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010623generate-certificates
10624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10625 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10626 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10627 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10628 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10629 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10630 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10631 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10632 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10633 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10634 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10635
10636 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10637 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10638 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10639 certificate is used many times.
10640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010641gid <gid>
10642 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10643 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10644 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10645 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10646 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10647
10648group <group>
10649 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10650 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10651 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10652 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10653 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10654
10655id <id>
10656 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10657 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10658 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10659 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10660
10661interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010662 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10663 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10664 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10665 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10666 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10667 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10668 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010669
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010670level <level>
10671 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10672 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10673 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10674 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10675 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10676 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10677 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10678 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10679 counters).
10680 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10681 all counters).
10682
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010683severity-output <format>
10684 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10685 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10686 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10687 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10688 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10689 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10690 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10691 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10692 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10693 rfc5424 convention.
10694
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010695maxconn <maxconn>
10696 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10697 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10698 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10699 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10700 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10701 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10702 eat all memory.
10703
10704mode <mode>
10705 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10706 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10707 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10708 UNIX sockets.
10709
10710mss <maxseg>
10711 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10712 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10713 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10714 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10715 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10716 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10717 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10718 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10719 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10720 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10721 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10722
10723name <name>
10724 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10725 page.
10726
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010727namespace <name>
10728 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10729 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10730 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10731 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10732
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010733nice <nice>
10734 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10735 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10736 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10737 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10738 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10739 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10740 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10741 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10742 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10743 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10744 one for an RDP socket.
10745
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010746no-ca-names
10747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10748 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10749
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010750no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010752 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010753 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010754 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010755 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10756 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010757
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010758no-tls-tickets
10759 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10760 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10761 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010762 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10763 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010764
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010765no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010767 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010768 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010769 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010770 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10771 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010772
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010773no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010775 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010776 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010777 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010778 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10779 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010780
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010781no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010783 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010784 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010785 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010786 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10787 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010788
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010789no-tlsv13
10790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10791 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10792 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10793 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010794 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10795 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010796
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010797npn <protocols>
10798 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10799 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10800 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10801 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010802 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10803 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010804
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010805prefer-client-ciphers
10806 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10807 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10808 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10809
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010810process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10811 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10812 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10813 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10814 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10815 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10816 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10817 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010818 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10819 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10820 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10821 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10822 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10823 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10824 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010825
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010826ssl
10827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010828 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010829 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10830 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010831 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10832 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010833
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010834ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10835 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10836 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10837 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10838
10839ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10840 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10841 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10842 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10843
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010844strict-sni
10845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10846 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10847 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10848 See the "crt" option for more information.
10849
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010850tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010851 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010852 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10853 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010854 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010855 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10856 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10857 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10858 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10859 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10860 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10861 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10862
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010863tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010864 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010865 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10866 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10867 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10868 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10869 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10870 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10871 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010872 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10873 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10874 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010875
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010876tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10877 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10878 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10879 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10880 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10881 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10882 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10883 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10884 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10885 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10886 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10887
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010888transparent
10889 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10890 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10891 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10892 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10893 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10894 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10895 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10896 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10897 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10898 so check for support with your vendor.
10899
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010900v4v6
10901 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10902 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10903 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10904 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010905 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010906
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010907v6only
10908 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10909 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10910 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010911 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10912 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010913
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010914uid <uid>
10915 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10916 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10917 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10918 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10919 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10920
10921user <user>
10922 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10923 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10924 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10925 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10926 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10927
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010928verify [none|optional|required]
10929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10930 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10931 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10932 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10933 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010934 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10935 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10936 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10937 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010938
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200109395.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010940------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010942The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10943which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10944arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10945settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10946after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10947Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10948address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010950 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010951 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010952
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010953Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10954keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010956The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010957
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010958addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010959 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010960 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10961 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10962 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10963 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10964 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010965
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010966agent-check
10967 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010968 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10969 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10970 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10971 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010972
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010973 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010974 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010975 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10976 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10977 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010978
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010979 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10980 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10981 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10982 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10983 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10984
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010985 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10986 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010987
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010988 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10989 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10990 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010991
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010992 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10993 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10994 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010995
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010996 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10997 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10998 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10999 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11000 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
11001 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
11002 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011003
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011004 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11005 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011006
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011007 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11008 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11009 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11010 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11011 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11012 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11013 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11014 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11015 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011016
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011017 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11018 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011019 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11020 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11021 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011022 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011023
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011024 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011025 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011026
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011027agent-send <string>
11028 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11029 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11030 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11031 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11032 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11033
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011034agent-inter <delay>
11035 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11036 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11037
11038 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11039 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11040 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11041 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11042 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11043 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11044 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11045 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11046 of backends use the same servers.
11047
11048 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11049
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011050agent-addr <addr>
11051 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11052
11053 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11054 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11055 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11056 hostname, it will be resolved.
11057
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011058agent-port <port>
11059 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11060
11061 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011063backup
11064 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11065 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11066 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11067 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011068 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11069 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011070
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011071ca-file <cafile>
11072 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11073 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11074 server's certificate.
11075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011076check
11077 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011078 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11079 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11080 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11081 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11082 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11083 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11084 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011085 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11086 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011087 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11088 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011089
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011090check-send-proxy
11091 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11092 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11093 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11094 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11095 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11096 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11097 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11098
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011099check-sni
11100 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11101 over SSL.
11102
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011103check-ssl
11104 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11105 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11106 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11107 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011108 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011109 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11110 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11111 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011112 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11113 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011114
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011115ciphers <ciphers>
11116 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011117 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011118 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11119 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11120 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11121 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11122 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11123 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011125cookie <value>
11126 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11127 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11128 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11129 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11130 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11131 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11132 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11133
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011134crl-file <crlfile>
11135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11136 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11137 to verify server's certificate.
11138
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011139crt <cert>
11140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11141 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11142 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11143 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11144 certificate request.
11145
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011146disabled
11147 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11148 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11149 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11150 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11151 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011152 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011153
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011154enabled
11155 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11156 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11157 default value.
11158 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11159 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011161error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011162 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11163 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11164 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011166 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011168fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011169 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11170 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11171 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11172
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011173force-sslv3
11174 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11175 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011176 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011177 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011178
11179force-tlsv10
11180 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011181 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011182 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011183
11184force-tlsv11
11185 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011186 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011187 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011188
11189force-tlsv12
11190 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011191 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011192 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011193
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011194force-tlsv13
11195 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11196 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011197 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011199id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011200 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11201 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11202 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011203
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011204init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11205 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11206 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11207 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11208 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11209 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11210 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11211 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11212 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11213 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11214 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11215 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11216 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11217 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11218 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11219 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11220 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11221 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11222 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11223 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11224 historic behaviour.
11225
11226 Example:
11227 defaults
11228 # never fail on address resolution
11229 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011231inter <delay>
11232fastinter <delay>
11233downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11235 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11236 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11237 between checks depending on the server state :
11238
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011239 Server state | Interval used
11240 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11241 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11242 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11243 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11244 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11245 or yet unchecked. |
11246 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11247 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11248 | "inter" otherwise.
11249 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011251 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11252 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11253 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11254 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011255 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11256 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11257 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11258 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11259 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011261maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011262 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11263 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11264 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11265 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11266 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11267 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11268 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11269 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011271maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011272 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11273 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11274 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11275 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11276 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11277 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11278 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011280minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011281 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11282 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11283 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11284 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11285 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11286 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011287 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011288 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011289
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011290namespace <name>
11291 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11292 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11293 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11294 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11295
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011296no-agent-check
11297 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11298 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11299 default value.
11300 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11301 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11302
11303no-backup
11304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11306 default value.
11307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11308 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11309
11310no-check
11311 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11312 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11313 default value.
11314 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11315 "default-server" "check" setting.
11316
11317no-check-ssl
11318 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11319 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11320 default value.
11321 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11322 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11323
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011324no-send-proxy
11325 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11326 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11327 default value.
11328 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11329 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11330
11331no-send-proxy-v2
11332 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11333 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11334 default value.
11335 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11336 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11337
11338no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11339 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11340 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11341 default value.
11342 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11343 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11344
11345no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11346 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11347 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11348 default value.
11349 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11350 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11351
11352no-ssl
11353 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11354 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11355 default value.
11356 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11357 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11358
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011359no-ssl-reuse
11360 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11361 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11362 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11363 and for paranoid users.
11364
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011365no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011366 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11367 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011368 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011369
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011370 Supported in default-server: No
11371
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011372no-tls-tickets
11373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11374 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11375 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011376 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11377 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011378 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011379
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011380no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011381 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011382 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11383 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011384 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11385 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011386 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011387
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011388 Supported in default-server: No
11389
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011390no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011391 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011392 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11393 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011394 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11395 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011396 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011397
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011398 Supported in default-server: No
11399
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011400no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011401 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011402 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11403 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011404 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11405 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011406 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011407
11408 Supported in default-server: No
11409
11410no-tlsv13
11411 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11412 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11413 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11414 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11415 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011416 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011417
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011418 Supported in default-server: No
11419
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011420no-verifyhost
11421 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11422 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11423 default value.
11424 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11425 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011426
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011427non-stick
11428 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11429 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11430 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011432observe <mode>
11433 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11434 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11435 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11436 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11437 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11438 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011439 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011440
11441 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011443on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011444 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11445 Currently, four modes are available:
11446 - fastinter: force fastinter
11447 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11448 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11449 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11450 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11451
11452 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11453
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011454on-marked-down <action>
11455 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11456 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011457 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11458 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11459 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11460 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11461 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11462 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11463 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11464 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011465
11466 Actions are disabled by default
11467
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011468on-marked-up <action>
11469 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11470 Currently one action is available:
11471 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11472 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11473 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11474 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11475 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11476 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11477 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11478 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11479
11480 Actions are disabled by default
11481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011482port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011483 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11484 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11485 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11486 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11487 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11488 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11489
11490redir <prefix>
11491 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11492 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11493 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11494 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11495 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11496 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11497 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11498 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011499 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011500 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11501 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11502 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11503 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11504 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11505
11506 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011508rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011509 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11510 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11511 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11512
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011513resolve-prefer <family>
11514 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11515 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11516 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11517 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11518
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011519 Default value: ipv6
11520
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011521 Example:
11522
11523 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011524
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011525resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11526 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11527 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011528 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011529 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11530 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11531 configured network, another address is selected.
11532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011533 Example:
11534
11535 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011536
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011537resolvers <id>
11538 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11539 hostname.
11540
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011541 Example:
11542
11543 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011544
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011545 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011546
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011547send-proxy
11548 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11549 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11550 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11551 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011552 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11553 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11554 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11555 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11556 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11557 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11558 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11559 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11560 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11561 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011562 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11563 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011564
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011565send-proxy-v2
11566 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11567 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11568 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11569 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011570 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11571 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11572 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11573 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011574
11575send-proxy-v2-ssl
11576 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11577 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11578 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11579 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11580 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11581 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11582 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011583 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11584 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011585
11586send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11587 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11588 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11589 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11590 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11591 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11592 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11593 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11594 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011595 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11596 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011598slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011599 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11600 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11601 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11602 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11603 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11604 parameters :
11605
11606 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11607 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11608
11609 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11610 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11611 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11612 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11613
11614 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11615 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11616 seen as failed.
11617
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011618sni <expression>
11619 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11620 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11621 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11622 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011623 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11624 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011625 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11626 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011627
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011628source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011629source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011630source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011631 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11632 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11633 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11634 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11635
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011636 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11637 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11638 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11639 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11640 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11641 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11642 server.
11643
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011644 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11645 specifying the source address without port(s).
11646
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011647ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011648 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11649 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11650 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11651 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11652 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11653 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011654 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11655 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011656
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011657ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11658 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11659 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11660 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11661
11662ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11663 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11664 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11665 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11666
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011667ssl-reuse
11668 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11669 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11670 default value.
11671 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11672 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11673
11674stick
11675 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11676 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11677 default value.
11678 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11679 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011680
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011681tcp-ut <delay>
11682 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11683 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11684 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011685 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011686 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11687 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11688 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11689 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11690 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11691 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11692 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11693 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11694 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011696track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011697 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11698 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11699 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11700 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011701 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11702
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011703tls-tickets
11704 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11705 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11706 default value.
11707 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11708 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011709
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011710verify [none|required]
11711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011712 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011713 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11714 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11715 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11716 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11717 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11718 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11719 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11720 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11721 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11722 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11723 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011724
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011725verifyhost <hostname>
11726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011727 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11728 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11729 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11730 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11731 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11732 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11733 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11734 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011736weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011737 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11738 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11739 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011740 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11741 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11742 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11743 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11744 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11745 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011746
11747
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117485.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11749-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011750
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011751HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11752using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11753configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011754This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11755can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11756workload.
11757This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11758resolution at run time.
11759Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11760carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11761
11762
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117635.3.1. Global overview
11764----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011765
11766As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11767different steps of the process life:
11768
11769 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11770 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11771 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11772
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011773 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11774 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011775
11776A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11777 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11778 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11779 resolution to know this new IP.
11780
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011781When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11782HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11783SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11784from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11785will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11786will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011787
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011788A few things important to notice:
11789 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11790 first valid response.
11791
11792 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11793 servers return an error.
11794
11795
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117965.3.2. The resolvers section
11797----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011798
11799This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011800HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11801contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011802
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011803When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11804uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11805is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11806answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11807
11808When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011809used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011810
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011811 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11812 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11813 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011814
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011815 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11816 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011817
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011818 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11819 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11820 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011821
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011822For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11823following scenarios are possible:
11824
11825 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11826 ignored
11827
11828 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11829 applied
11830
11831 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11832 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11833
11834 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11835 retries the query with a new type
11836
11837 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11838 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011839
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011840As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11841a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011842<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011843
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011844
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011845resolvers <resolvers id>
11846 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11847
11848A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11849
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011850accepted_payload_size <nb>
11851 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011852 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011853 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11854 by RFC 6891)
11855
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011856 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011857 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11858
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011859 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11860
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011861nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11862 DNS server description:
11863 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11864 <ip> : IP address of the server
11865 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11866
11867hold <status> <period>
11868 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11869 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011870 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011871 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011872 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11873 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11874 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11875
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011876 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011877
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011878resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011879 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11880 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11881 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11882
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011883resolve_retries <nb>
11884 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11885 giving up.
11886 Default value: 3
11887
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011888 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11889 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11890 type.
11891
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011892timeout <event> <time>
11893 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11894 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11895 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011896 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11897 other time applied.
11898 Default value: 1s
11899 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11900 have been received.
11901 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011902 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11903 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11904
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011905 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011906
11907 resolvers mydns
11908 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11909 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11910 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011911 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011912 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011913 hold other 30s
11914 hold refused 30s
11915 hold nx 30s
11916 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011917 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011918 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011919
11920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119216. HTTP header manipulation
11922---------------------------
11923
11924In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11925response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11926request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11927which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011928against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011929
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011930If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11931to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11932but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11933HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11934stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11935because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11936a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11937still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011939This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11940in section 4.2 :
11941
11942 - reqadd <string>
11943 - reqallow <search>
11944 - reqiallow <search>
11945 - reqdel <search>
11946 - reqidel <search>
11947 - reqdeny <search>
11948 - reqideny <search>
11949 - reqpass <search>
11950 - reqipass <search>
11951 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11952 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11953 - reqtarpit <search>
11954 - reqitarpit <search>
11955 - rspadd <string>
11956 - rspdel <search>
11957 - rspidel <search>
11958 - rspdeny <search>
11959 - rspideny <search>
11960 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11961 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11962
11963With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11964is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11965parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11966prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11967Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11968
11969 \t for a tab
11970 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11971 \n for a new line (LF)
11972 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11973 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11974 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11975 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11976 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11977
11978The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11979portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11980above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11981regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119829 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11983is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11984
11985The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11986after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11987
11988Notes related to these keywords :
11989---------------------------------
11990 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11991 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11992 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11993
11994 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11995 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11996 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11997
11998 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11999 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12000 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12001 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12002 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12003
12004 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12005 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12006 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12007 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12008 useless headers before adding new ones.
12009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012010 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012011 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12012
12013 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12014 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12015 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12016
12017 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12018 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012019 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012020
12021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120227. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12023----------------------------------
12024
12025Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
12026client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12027The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12028these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12029but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12030data called patterns.
12031
12032
120337.1. ACL basics
12034---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012035
12036The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12037content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12038from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12039simple :
12040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012042 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012043 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12044 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12047adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012048
12049In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012051 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012052
12053This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12054Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12055and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012056an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12057conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12058as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12059are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012060
12061ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12062'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12063which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12064
12065There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12066performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012068The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12069specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12070this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012071methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12072ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012073
12074Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12075 - boolean
12076 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12077 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12078 - string
12079 - data block
12080
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012081Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12082converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12083would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12084The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12085which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12086
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012087Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12088keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12089fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12090which are summarized in the table below :
12091
12092 +---------------------+-----------------+
12093 | Sample or converter | Default |
12094 | output type | matching method |
12095 +---------------------+-----------------+
12096 | boolean | bool |
12097 +---------------------+-----------------+
12098 | integer | int |
12099 +---------------------+-----------------+
12100 | ip | ip |
12101 +---------------------+-----------------+
12102 | string | str |
12103 +---------------------+-----------------+
12104 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12105 +---------------------+-----------------+
12106
12107Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12108matching method, see below.
12109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012110The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12111 - boolean
12112 - integer or integer range
12113 - IP address / network
12114 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12115 - regular expression
12116 - hex block
12117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012118The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12119
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012120 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12121 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012122 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012123 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012124 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012125 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012126 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012128The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12129read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12130if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12131lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12132will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12133beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12134a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12135lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12136exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12137
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012138The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12139parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12140ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12141a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12142check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12143
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012144The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12145socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12146file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012148Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12149loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12150
12151 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12152
12153In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12154the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12155case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12156as well.
12157
12158The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12159sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12160do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12161methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12162is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12163obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12164followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12165default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12166that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12167string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12168
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012169The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12170By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12171string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12172resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12173server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12174waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12175flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12176function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012178There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12179sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12180be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012181
12182 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12183 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012184 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12185 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12186 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12187 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012188
12189 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12190 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012191 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012192
12193 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012194 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012195
12196 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012197 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012198
12199 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12200 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12201
12202 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12203 binary or string samples.
12204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012205 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12206 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012208 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12209 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12210 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012212 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12213 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012215 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12216 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012218 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12219 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012221 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12222 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012223 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012225 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12226 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12227 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012228
12229For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12230request, it is possible to do :
12231
12232 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12233
12234In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12235buffer, one would use the following acl :
12236
12237 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12238
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012239On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12240possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12241
12242 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012244All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12245criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12246method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12247to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12248criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12249the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012251If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012252the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12253For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012255 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12256 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12257 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12258 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012259
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012260
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012261The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12262types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12263combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12264brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12265default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012267 +-------------------------------------------------+
12268 | Input sample type |
12269 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012270 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12272 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12273 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012274 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012275 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012276 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012277 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012278 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012280 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012281 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012282 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012283 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012284 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012285 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012286 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012287 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012288 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012289 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012290 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012291 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012292 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012293 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012294 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012295 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12296 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12297 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012298
12299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123007.1.1. Matching booleans
12301------------------------
12302
12303In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12304Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12305When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12306that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12307
12308Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12309return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12310"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12311
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123137.1.2. Matching integers
12314------------------------
12315
12316Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12317enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12318to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12319
12320Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12321matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12322lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012323
12324For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12325unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12326representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12327
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012328As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12329two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12330instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12331ranges and operators.
12332
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012333For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012334operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12335Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12336of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012338Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012339
12340 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12341 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12342 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12343 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12344 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012346For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012347
12348 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12349
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12351
12352 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12353
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123557.1.3. Matching strings
12356-----------------------
12357
12358String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12359different forms :
12360
12361 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12362 patterns ;
12363
12364 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12365 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12366
12367 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12368 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12369
12370 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12371 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12372
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012373 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012374 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12375 matches.
12376
12377 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12378 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12379 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012380
12381String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12382exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12383characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12384string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12385to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012386before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012387
12388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123897.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12390---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012391
12392Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12393they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12394possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12395passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12396the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012397the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12398match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012399
12400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124017.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12402-------------------------------------
12403
12404It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12405not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12406a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12407to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12408digits may be used upper or lower case.
12409
12410Example :
12411 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12412 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12413
12414
124157.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12416---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012417
12418IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12419netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12420within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012421host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012422difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12423at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12424does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12425parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012426
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012427The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12428abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12429
12430 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12431 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12432 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12433 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12434 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12435 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12436 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12437 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12438
12439Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12440192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12441
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012442IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12443Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12444trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12445IPv6 patterns.
12446
12447HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12448following situations :
12449 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12450 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12451 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12452 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12453 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12454 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12455 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12456 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12457 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12458 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460
124617.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12462----------------------------------
12463
12464Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12465combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12466
12467 - AND (implicit)
12468 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12469 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012471A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012473 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012475Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12476indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12479"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12480requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12481is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12482
12483 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012484 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12485 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12486 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012487
12488To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12489and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12490
12491 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12492 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12493 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12494 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12495
12496 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12497 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12498 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12499 use_backend www if host_www
12500
12501It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12502expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12503be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12504the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12505
12506 The following rule :
12507
12508 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012509 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012510
12511 Can also be written that way :
12512
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012513 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514
12515It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12516to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12517simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12518sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12519good use is the following :
12520
12521 With named ACLs :
12522
12523 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12524 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12525 monitor fail if site_dead
12526
12527 With anonymous ACLs :
12528
12529 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12530
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012531See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12532keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012533
12534
125357.3. Fetching samples
12536---------------------
12537
12538Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12539against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12540sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12541ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12542of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12543available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12544
12545This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12546Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12547compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12548deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12549
12550The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12551matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12552method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12553indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12554
12555As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12556when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12557mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12558the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12559ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12560
12561Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12562multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12563when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12564incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12565are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12566is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12567all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12568
12569Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12570 - name
12571 - name(arg1)
12572 - name(arg1,arg2)
12573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012574
125757.3.1. Converters
12576-----------------
12577
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012578Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12579of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12580is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12581was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12582has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12583unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12584
12585These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12586sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12587the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12588support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012589
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012590A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12591support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12592supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12593(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12594bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012596The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012597
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001259851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12599 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12600 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12601 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12602 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12603 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12604
12605 Example :
12606 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12607 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12608 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12609 frontend http-in
12610 bind *:8081
12611 default_backend servers
12612 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12613 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12614
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012615add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012616 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012617 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012618 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12619 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012627
12628and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012629 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012630 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012631 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12632 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012633 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012634 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12635 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12636 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12637 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12638 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012639 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012640
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012641b64dec
12642 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12643 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12644
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012645base64
12646 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12647 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12648 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12649
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012650bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012651 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012652 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12653 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12654 presence of a flag).
12655
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012656bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12657 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12658 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012659 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012660
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012661cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012662 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12663 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012664
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012665crc32([<avalanche>])
12666 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12667 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12668 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12669 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12670 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12671 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12672 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12673 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12674 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12675 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12676 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12677
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012678da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012679 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12680 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12681 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12682 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012683 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012684 configuration language.
12685
12686 Example:
12687 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012688 bind *:8881
12689 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012690 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012691
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012692debug
12693 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12694 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12695 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12696
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012697div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012698 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12699 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012700 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012701 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12702 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012703 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012704 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12705 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12706 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12707 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12708 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012709 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012710
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012711djb2([<avalanche>])
12712 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12713 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12714 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12715 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12716 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12717 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12718 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012719 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12720 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012721
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012722even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012723 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012724 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12725
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012726field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12727 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12728 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12729 list of chars.
12730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012731hex
12732 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12733 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12734 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12735 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012736
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012737hex2i
12738 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12739 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12740
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012741http_date([<offset>])
12742 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12743 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12744 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12745 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12746 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12747 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012749in_table(<table>)
12750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12752 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12753 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12754 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12755
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012756ipmask(<mask>)
12757 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12758 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12759 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12760 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12761
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012762json([<input-code>])
12763 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12764 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012765 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012766 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12767 of errors:
12768 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12769 bytes, ...)
12770 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12771 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12772
12773 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12774 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12775 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12776 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12777 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12778 are :
12779 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12780 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12781 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12782 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12783 error ;
12784 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12785 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12786
12787 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12788 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12789
12790 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012791 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012792 capture request header user-agent len 150
12793 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012794
12795 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12796 GET / HTTP/1.0
12797 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12798
12799 Output log:
12800 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12801
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012802language(<value>[,<default>])
12803 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12804 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12805 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12806 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12807 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12808 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12809 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12810 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12811 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12812 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12813 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12814 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012815
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012816 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012818 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12819 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012820
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012821 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12822 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12823 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12824 use_backend spanish if es
12825 use_backend french if fr
12826 use_backend english if en
12827 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012828
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012829lower
12830 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12831 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12832 type. The result is of type string.
12833
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012834ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12835 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12836 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12837 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12838 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12839 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12840 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12841
12842 Example :
12843
12844 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12845 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12846 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12847
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012848map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12849map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12850map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12851 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12852 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12853 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12854 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12855 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12856 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12857 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12858 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012859
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012860 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12861 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12862 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012863
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012864 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012865 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012866
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012867 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12868 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12869 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12870 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012871 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12872 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012873 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12874 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12875 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12876 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12877 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12878 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12879 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12880 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012881 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12882 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12883 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012884 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12885 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12886 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12887 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12888 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012889
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012890 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12891 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12892 the corresponding match text.
12893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012894 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12895 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12896 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12897 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12898 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012899
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012900 Example :
12901
12902 # this is a comment and is ignored
12903 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12904 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12905 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12906 | | | `---------- value
12907 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12908 | `---------------------------- key
12909 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12910
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012911mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012912 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12913 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012914 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012915 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012916 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012917 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12918 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12919 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12920 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12921 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012922 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012923
12924mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012925 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012926 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12927 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012928 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012929 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012930 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012931 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12932 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12933 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012936 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012937
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012938nbsrv
12939 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12940 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12941 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12942 map lookup.
12943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012944neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012945 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12946 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12947 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12948 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012949
12950not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012951 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012952 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12953 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12954 absence of a flag).
12955
12956odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012957 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012958 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12959
12960or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012961 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012962 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012963 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12964 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012965 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012966 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12967 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12968 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12969 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012971 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012972
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012973regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012974 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12975 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12976 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12977 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12978 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12979 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12980 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12981 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12982 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12983 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012984 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12985 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12986 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12987 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012988
12989 Example :
12990
12991 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12992 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12993 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12994 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12995
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012996capture-req(<id>)
12997 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12998 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12999
13000 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013001 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13002 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013003
13004capture-res(<id>)
13005 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13006 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13007
13008 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013009 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13010 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013011
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013012sdbm([<avalanche>])
13013 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13014 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13015 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13016 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13017 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13018 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13019 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013020 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
13021 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013022
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013023set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013024 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
13025 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
13026 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013027 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013028 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13029 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013030 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013031 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13032 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013033 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013034 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013035
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013036sha1
13037 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13038 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13039
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013040sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013041 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13042 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013043 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013044 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13045 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013046 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013047 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13048 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013049 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013050 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13051 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013052 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013053 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013054
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013055table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13059 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13060 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13061 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13062
13063
13064table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13067 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13068 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13069 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13070 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13071
13072table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13073 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13074 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13075 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13076 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13077 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13078
13079table_conn_cur(<table>)
13080 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13081 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13082 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13083 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13084 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13085
13086table_conn_rate(<table>)
13087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13090 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13091 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13092
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013093table_gpt0(<table>)
13094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13097 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13098 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13099
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013100table_gpc0(<table>)
13101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13104 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13105 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13106
13107table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13108 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13109 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13110 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13111 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13112 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13113 sample fetch keyword.
13114
13115table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13118 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13119 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13120 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13121
13122table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13125 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13126 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13127 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13128 keyword.
13129
13130table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13131 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13132 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13133 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13134 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13135 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13136
13137table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13140 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13141 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13142 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13143 keyword.
13144
13145table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13148 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13149 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13150 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13151 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13152 keyword.
13153
13154table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13155 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13156 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13157 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13158 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13159 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13160 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13161 keyword.
13162
13163table_server_id(<table>)
13164 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13165 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13166 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13167 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13168 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13169 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13170
13171table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13172 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13173 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13174 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13175 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13176 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13177 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13178 keyword.
13179
13180table_sess_rate(<table>)
13181 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13182 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13183 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13184 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13185 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13186 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13187 keyword.
13188
13189table_trackers(<table>)
13190 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13191 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13192 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13193 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13194 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13195 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13196 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13197 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13198 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13199 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13200
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013201upper
13202 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13203 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13204 type. The result is of type string.
13205
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013206url_dec
13207 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13208 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13209
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013210unset-var(<var name>)
13211 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13212 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13213 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13214 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13215 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13216 response),
13217 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13218 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13219 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13220 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13221
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013222utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13223 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13224 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13225 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13226 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13227 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13228 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13229
13230 Example :
13231
13232 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13233 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13234 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13235
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013236word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13237 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13238 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13239
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013240wt6([<avalanche>])
13241 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13242 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13243 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13244 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13245 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13246 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13247 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013248 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13249 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013250
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013251xor(<value>)
13252 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013253 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013254 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013255 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013256 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013257 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13258 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013259 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013260 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13261 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013262 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013263 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013264
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013265xxh32([<seed>])
13266 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13267 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13268 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13269 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13270 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13271 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13272 as cryptographically secure.
13273
13274xxh64([<seed>])
13275 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13276 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13277 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13278 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13279 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13280 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13281 as cryptographically secure.
13282
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013283
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285--------------------------------------------
13286
13287A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13288not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13289"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13290The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13291
13292always_false : boolean
13293 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13294 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13295
13296always_true : boolean
13297 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13298 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13299
13300avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013301 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13303 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13304 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13305 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13306 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13307 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13308 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13309 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13310 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13311 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13312 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13313 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13314 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013316be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013317 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13318 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13319 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13320 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13321 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13325 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13326 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13327 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13328 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13329 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013330
13331 Example :
13332 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13333 backend dynamic
13334 mode http
13335 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13336 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013337
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013338bin(<hexa>) : bin
13339 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13340 of the string.
13341
13342bool(<bool>) : bool
13343 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13344 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13347 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013348 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013349 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13350 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013351
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013352 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013353 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013354 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13355
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013356 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13357 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013358
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013359 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013360 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013362 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13363 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013365 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013366
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013367 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13368 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013369 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013370 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013371
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013372date([<offset>]) : integer
13373 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13374 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13375 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13376 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013377 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13378
13379 Example :
13380
13381 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13382 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013383
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013384distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13385 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13386 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13387 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13388 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13389 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13390 list of supported tokens.
13391
13392distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13393 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13394 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13395 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13396 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13397 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13398 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13399 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13400 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13401 supported tokens.
13402
13403 Example :
13404 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13405 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13406 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13407 # send large files to the big farm
13408 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13409
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013410env(<name>) : string
13411 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13412 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13413 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13414 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13415 certain way.
13416
13417 Examples :
13418 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13419 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13420
13421 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13422 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13425 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013426 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13427 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13429 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13430 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13431 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13432 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013433
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013434fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13436 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13437 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13441 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13442 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13443 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13444 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13445 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13446 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13447 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013448
13449 Example :
13450 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13451 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13452 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13453 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13454 frontend mail
13455 bind :25
13456 mode tcp
13457 maxconn 100
13458 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13459 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13460 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13461 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013462
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013463hostname : string
13464 Returns the system hostname.
13465
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013466int(<integer>) : signed integer
13467 Returns a signed integer.
13468
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013469ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13470 Returns an ipv4.
13471
13472ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13473 Returns an ipv6.
13474
13475meth(<method>) : method
13476 Returns a method.
13477
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013478nbproc : integer
13479 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13480 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13481 and debugging purposes.
13482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013483nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13485 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13486 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013487 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13488 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13489 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013490
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013491proc : integer
13492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13493 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13494 debugging purposes.
13495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013496queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013497 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13498 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13499 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013500 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13501 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13502 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13503 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13504 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13505
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013506rand([<range>]) : integer
13507 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13508 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13509 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13510 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13511 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13514 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13515 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13516 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13517 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13518 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13519 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13520 methods.
13521
13522srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13523 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13524 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13525 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13526 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13527 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13528 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13529 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13530
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013531srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13533 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13534 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13535 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13536 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13537 fetch methods.
13538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013539srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13540 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13541 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013542 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13544 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13545 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13546 overloading servers).
13547
13548 Example :
13549 # Redirect to a separate back
13550 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13551 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13552 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13553
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013554stopping : boolean
13555 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13556 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13557 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13558
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013559str(<string>) : string
13560 Returns a string.
13561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13563 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13564 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13565
13566table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13567 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13568 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13569 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13570
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013571thread : integer
13572 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13573 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13574 and debugging purposes.
13575
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013576var(<var-name>) : undefined
13577 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013578 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13579 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013580 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013581 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13582 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013583 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013584 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13585 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013586 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013587 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013588
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590----------------------------------
13591
13592The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13593closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13594methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13595sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13596TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013597the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13598counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13599"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013600argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13601the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13602this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603
13604be_id : integer
13605 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13606 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13607
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013608be_name : string
13609 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13610 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013612dst : ip
13613 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13614 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13615 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13616 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13617 RFC 4291.
13618
13619dst_conn : integer
13620 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13621 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13622 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13623 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13624 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13625 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13626 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13627 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013628
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013629dst_is_local : boolean
13630 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13631 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13632 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13633 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13634 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13635 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13636 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13637 it only once per connection.
13638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639dst_port : integer
13640 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13641 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13642 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13643 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13644 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13645 an HTTP header.
13646
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013647fc_http_major : integer
13648 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13649 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13650 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13651
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013652fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13653 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13654 header.
13655
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013656fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13657 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13658 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13659 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13660 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13661 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13662 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13663
13664fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13665 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13666 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13667 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13668 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13669 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13670 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13671
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013672fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13673 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13674 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13675 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13676 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13677
13678fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13679 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13680 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13681 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13682 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13683
13684fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13685 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13686 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13687 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13688 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13689
13690fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13691 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13692 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13693 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13694 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13695
13696fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13697 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13698 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13699 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13700 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13701
13702fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13703 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13704 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13705 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13706 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708fe_id : integer
13709 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013710 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013711 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13712
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013713fe_name : string
13714 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13715 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13716 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013718sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013719sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13720sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13721sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013722 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13723 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13724 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013726sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013727sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13728sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13729sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013730 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13731 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13732 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13733
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013734sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013735sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13736sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13737sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013738 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13739 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013740 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13741 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13742 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013743
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013744 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013745 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13746 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013747 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13748 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13749 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013750 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13751 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13752
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013753sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013754sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13755sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13756sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013757 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13758 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13759
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013760sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013761sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13762sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13763sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013764 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13765 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13766 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13767
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013768sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013769sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13770sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13771sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013772 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13773 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13774 See also src_conn_rate.
13775
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013776sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013777sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13778sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13779sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013780 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013781 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013782
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013783sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13784sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13785sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13786sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13787 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13788 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013790sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013791sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13792sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13793sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013794 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13795 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13796 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013797 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13798 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13799 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013801sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013802sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13803sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13804sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013805 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13806 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13807 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013809sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013810sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13811sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13812sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013813 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13814 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13815 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13816 src_http_err_rate.
13817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013818sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013819sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13820sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13821sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013822 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13823 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13824 src_http_req_cnt.
13825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013826sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013827sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13828sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13829sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013830 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13831 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13832 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13833 src_http_req_rate.
13834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013835sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013836sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13837sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13838sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013839 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013840 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13841 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13842 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13843 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013844
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013845 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013846 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13847 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013848 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13849
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013850sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013851sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13852sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13853sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013854 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13855 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13856 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013857
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013858sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013859sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13860sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13861sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013862 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13863 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13864 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013866sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013867sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13868sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13869sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013870 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13871 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13872 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13873 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013874 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013875 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13876
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013877sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013878sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13879sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13880sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013881 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13882 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13883 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13884 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13885 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013886 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013888sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013889sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13890sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13891sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013892 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13893 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13894 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013896sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013897sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13898sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13899sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013900 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13901 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013902 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013903 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13904 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13906 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13907 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909so_id : integer
13910 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13911 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13912 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914src : ip
13915 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13916 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13917 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13918 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013919 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13920 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13921 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13922 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013923
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013924 Example:
13925 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13926 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013928src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13929 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13930 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13931 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013932 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13935 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13936 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013937 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013938 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013940src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13941 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13942 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13943 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13944 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13945 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13946 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013947
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013948 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013949 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13950 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13951 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13952 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013953 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013954 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13955 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013958 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013960 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013961 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013964 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13966 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013967 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13970 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13971 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13972 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013973 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013976 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013977 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013978 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013979 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013980
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013981src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13982 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13983 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13984 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13985 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013987src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013988 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013990 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13991 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013992 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13993 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13994 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13997 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13998 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013999 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014000 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014003src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14004 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14005 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14006 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14007 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014008 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14011 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14012 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14013 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014014 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14017 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14018 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14019 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014020 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014021 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14024 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14025 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14026 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014027 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14029 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014030
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014031 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014032 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014033 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014034 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014035
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014036src_is_local : boolean
14037 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14038 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14039 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14040 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
14041 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
14042 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14043 once per connection.
14044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014046 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14047 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14048 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14049 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14050 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014052src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014053 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14054 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14055 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14056 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14057 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059src_port : integer
14060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14061 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14062 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14063 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14066 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014067 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14068 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14069 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014070 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014072src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14073 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14074 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14075 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14076 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014077 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14080 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14081 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14082 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14083 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14084 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14085 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14086 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14087 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014088
14089 Example :
14090 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14091 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14092 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14093 listen ssh
14094 bind :22
14095 mode tcp
14096 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014097 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014099 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101srv_id : integer
14102 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14103 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14104 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014105
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141067.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14110closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14111when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14112usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014113future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014114
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001411551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14116 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14117 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14118 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14119 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14120 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14121
14122 Example :
14123 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14124 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14125 # the request.
14126 frontend http-in
14127 bind *:8081
14128 default_backend servers
14129 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14130 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14131
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014132ssl_bc : boolean
14133 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14134 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14135 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14136
14137ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14138 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14139 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14140
14141ssl_bc_cipher : string
14142 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14143 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14144
14145ssl_bc_protocol : string
14146 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14147 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14148
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014149ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014150 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014151 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14152 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014153
14154ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14155 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14156 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14157 if session was reused or not.
14158
14159ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14160 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14161 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014163ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14164 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14165 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14166 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14167 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14168 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014170ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14172 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14173 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14174 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014175
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014176ssl_c_der : binary
14177 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14178 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14179 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181ssl_c_err : integer
14182 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14183 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14184 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14185 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14186 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014188ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14189 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14190 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14191 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14192 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14193 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14194 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14195 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14196 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014198ssl_c_key_alg : string
14199 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14200 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14201 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014203ssl_c_notafter : string
14204 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14205 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14206 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208ssl_c_notbefore : string
14209 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14210 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14211 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14214 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14215 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14216 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14217 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14218 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14219 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14220 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14221 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223ssl_c_serial : binary
14224 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14225 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14226 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14229 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14230 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14231 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014232 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14233 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14234
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014235 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014236 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14239 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14240 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14241 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243ssl_c_used : boolean
14244 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14245 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247ssl_c_verify : integer
14248 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14249 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14250 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14251 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253ssl_c_version : integer
14254 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14255 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014256
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014257ssl_f_der : binary
14258 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14259 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14260 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14263 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14264 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14265 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14266 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014267 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14269 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14270 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272ssl_f_key_alg : string
14273 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14274 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14275 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014277ssl_f_notafter : string
14278 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14279 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14280 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282ssl_f_notbefore : string
14283 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14284 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14285 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14288 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14289 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14290 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14291 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14292 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14293 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14294 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14295 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297ssl_f_serial : binary
14298 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14299 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14300 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014301
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014302ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14303 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14304 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14305 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014307ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14308 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14309 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14310 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312ssl_f_version : integer
14313 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14314 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14315
14316ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014317 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14318 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14319 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321 Example :
14322 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14323 listen http-https
14324 bind :80
14325 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14326 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14327
14328ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14329 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14330 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14331
14332ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014333 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14335 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14336 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14337 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14338 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14339 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14340 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14341 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343ssl_fc_cipher : string
14344 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14345 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014346
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014347ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14348 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14349 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014350 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014351
14352ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14353 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14354 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014355 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014356
14357ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14358 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14359 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14360 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014361 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14362 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014363
14364ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14365 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14366 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014367 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014370 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14371 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014372 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14373 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14374 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14375 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014376
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014377ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14378 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14379 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14380 wait until the handshake happened.
14381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14383 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014384 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14385 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14386 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14387 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014388
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014389ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014390 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14391 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014393ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014394 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14396 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14397 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14398 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14399 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14400 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14401 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014403ssl_fc_protocol : string
14404 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14405 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014406
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014407ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014408 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014409 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14410 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14413 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14414 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14415 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14416 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418ssl_fc_sni : string
14419 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14420 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14421 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14422 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14423 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14424
14425 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14426 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14427 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014428 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14429 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014431 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14433 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14436 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14437 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014438
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014441------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14444sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14445only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14446For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14447be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14448can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14449sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14450for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14451content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014453payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14454 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14455 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14456 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14459 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14460 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14461 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014462
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014463req.hdrs : string
14464 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14465 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14466 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14467 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14468
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014469req.hdrs_bin : binary
14470 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14471 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14472 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14473 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14474 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14475 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14476
14477 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14478
14479 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14480 str: <int:length><bytes>
14481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482req.len : integer
14483req_len : integer (deprecated)
14484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14485 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14486 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14487 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14488 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14489 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14490 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14491 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14494 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014495 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14496 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14497 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14498 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500 ACL alternatives :
14501 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14504 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14505 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14506 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14507 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 ACL alternatives :
14510 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014514req.proto_http : boolean
14515req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14516 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14517 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14518 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14519 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14520 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14521 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14522 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 Example:
14525 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14526 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14527 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014528 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14531rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14532 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14533 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14534 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14535 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14536 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14537 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14538 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14541 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14542 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14543 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14544 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14545 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014547 ACL derivatives :
14548 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550 Example :
14551 listen tse-farm
14552 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14553 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14554 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14555 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14556 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14557 persist rdp-cookie
14558 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14559 # This is only useful makes sense if
14560 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14561 stick-table type string size 204800
14562 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14563 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14564 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14567 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14570rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14571 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14572 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14573 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14574 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576 ACL derivatives :
14577 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014578
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014579req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14580 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14581 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014582 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14583 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14584 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14585 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14586 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014588req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14589req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14590 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14591 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14592 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14593 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14594 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14595 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14596 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598req.ssl_sni : string
14599req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14600 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14601 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14602 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14603 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14604 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14605 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14606 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14607 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14608 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14609 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14610 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14611 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 ACL derivatives :
14614 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616 Examples :
14617 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14618 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14619 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14620 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14621 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014622
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014623req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14624 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14625 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14626 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14627 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14628 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14629 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14630 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14631 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14632 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014634req.ssl_ver : integer
14635req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14636 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14637 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14638 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14639 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14640 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14641 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14642 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14643 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14644 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646 ACL derivatives :
14647 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014648
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014649res.len : integer
14650 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14651 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14652 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14653 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14654 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14655 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14656 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14657 content inspection.
14658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014659res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14660 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014661 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14662 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14663 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14664 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014666res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14667 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14668 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14669 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14670 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014673
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014674res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14675rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14676 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14677 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14678 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14679 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14680 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14681 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14682 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684wait_end : boolean
14685 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14686 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14687 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14688 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14689 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14690 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14691 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14692 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694 Examples :
14695 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14696 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14697 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014699 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14700 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14701 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14702 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14703 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14704 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14705 tcp-request content reject
14706
14707
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147087.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709--------------------------------------
14710
14711It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14712This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14713data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14714its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14715HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14716content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14717to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14718more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14719response are indexed.
14720
14721base : string
14722 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14723 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14724 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14725 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14726 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14727 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14728 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14729 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14730
14731 ACL derivatives :
14732 base : exact string match
14733 base_beg : prefix match
14734 base_dir : subdir match
14735 base_dom : domain match
14736 base_end : suffix match
14737 base_len : length match
14738 base_reg : regex match
14739 base_sub : substring match
14740
14741base32 : integer
14742 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14743 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14744 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014745 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14746 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14747 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014748
14749base32+src : binary
14750 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14751 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14752 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14753 per-URL counters.
14754
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014755capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14756 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14757 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14758 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14759
14760capture.req.method : string
14761 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14762 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14763 because it's allocated.
14764
14765capture.req.uri : string
14766 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14767 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14768 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14769 allocated.
14770
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014771capture.req.ver : string
14772 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14773 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14774 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14775
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014776capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14777 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14778 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14779 The first entry is an index of 0.
14780 See also: "capture response header"
14781
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014782capture.res.ver : string
14783 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14784 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14785 persistent flag.
14786
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014787req.body : binary
14788 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14789 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14790 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14791 the first chunk is analyzed.
14792
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014793req.body_param([<name>) : string
14794 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14795 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14796 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14797 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14798 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14799 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14800 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14801 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14802 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14803 given.
14804
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014805req.body_len : integer
14806 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14807 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14808 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14809 "option http-buffer-request".
14810
14811req.body_size : integer
14812 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14813 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14814 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14815 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14816 "option http-buffer-request".
14817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818req.cook([<name>]) : string
14819cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14820 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14821 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14822 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14823 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14824 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14825 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14826 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14827 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14828
14829 ACL derivatives :
14830 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14831 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14832 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14833 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14834 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14835 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14836 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14837 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14840cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14841 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14842 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14845cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14846 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14847 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14848 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14849 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14852 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14853 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14854 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14855 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014856 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14858 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14859 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14860 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14863 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14864 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14865 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14866 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014867 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14870 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14871 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14872 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14873 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14874 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14875 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14876 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14877 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14880 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14881 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14882 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14883 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14886 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14887 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14888 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14889 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14890 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14891 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14892 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14893 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014894 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14896 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898 ACL derivatives :
14899 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14900 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14901 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14902 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14903 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14904 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14905 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14906 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14907
14908req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14909hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14910 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14911 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14912 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14913 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14914 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14915 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14916 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14917 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14918 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14919
14920req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14921hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14922 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14923 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14924 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14925 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14926 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14927 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14928 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14929 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14930
14931req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14932hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14933 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14934 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14935 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14936 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14937 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14938 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14939 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14940
14941http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14942 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14943 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14944 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14945 basic auth is supported.
14946
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014947http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14948 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14949 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14950 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14951 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14953 basic auth is supported.
14954
14955 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014956 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14957 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14958 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14959 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960
14961http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014962 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14963 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14965 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967method : integer + string
14968 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14969 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14970 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14971 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14972 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14973 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14974 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976 ACL derivatives :
14977 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979 Example :
14980 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14981 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14982 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984path : string
14985 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14986 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14987 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14988 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14989 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14990 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14991 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993 ACL derivatives :
14994 path : exact string match
14995 path_beg : prefix match
14996 path_dir : subdir match
14997 path_dom : domain match
14998 path_end : suffix match
14999 path_len : length match
15000 path_reg : regex match
15001 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015002
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015003query : string
15004 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15005 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15006 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15007 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015008 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015009 which stops before the question mark.
15010
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015011req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15012 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15013 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15014 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15015 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017req.ver : string
15018req_ver : string (deprecated)
15019 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15020 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15021 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023 ACL derivatives :
15024 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026res.comp : boolean
15027 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15028 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15029 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031res.comp_algo : string
15032 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15033 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15034 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015036res.cook([<name>]) : string
15037scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15038 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15039 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15040 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015042 ACL derivatives :
15043 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15046scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15047 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15048 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15049 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15052scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15053 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15054 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15055 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15058 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15059 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15060 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15061 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15062 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15063 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15064 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15065 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15066 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15069 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15070 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15071 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15072 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15073 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15076shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15077 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15078 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15079 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15080 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15081 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15082 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15083 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15084 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 ACL derivatives :
15087 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15088 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15089 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15090 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15091 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15092 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15093 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15094 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15095
15096res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15097shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15098 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15099 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15100 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15101 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15102 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15105shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15106 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15107 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15108 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15109 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15110 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15111 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015112
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015113res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15114 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15115 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15116 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15117 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15120shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15121 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15122 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15123 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15124 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15125 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15126 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128res.ver : string
15129resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15130 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15131 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133 ACL derivatives :
15134 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15137 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15138 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015139 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15143 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145status : integer
15146 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15147 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15148 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015149
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015150unique-id : string
15151 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15152 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15153 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15154 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15155 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15156 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158url : string
15159 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15160 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15161 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15162 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15163 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15164 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15165 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167 ACL derivatives :
15168 url : exact string match
15169 url_beg : prefix match
15170 url_dir : subdir match
15171 url_dom : domain match
15172 url_end : suffix match
15173 url_len : length match
15174 url_reg : regex match
15175 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177url_ip : ip
15178 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15179 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15180 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15181 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15182 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15183 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15184 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186url_port : integer
15187 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15188 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15189 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15190 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015191
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015192urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15193url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15195 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015196 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15197 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15198 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15199 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15201 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015202 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15203 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205 ACL derivatives :
15206 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15207 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15208 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15209 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15210 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15211 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15212 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15213 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015214
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 Example :
15217 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15218 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15219 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15220 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015221
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015222urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015223 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15224 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15225 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015226
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015227url32 : integer
15228 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15229 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15230 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15231 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15232 is an unsigned integer.
15233
15234url32+src : binary
15235 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15236 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15237 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15238
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152407.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015241---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015243Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15244every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015245order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015247ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15248---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015249FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015250HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015251HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15252HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015253HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15254HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15255HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15256HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15257LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015258METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015259METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015260METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15261METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15262METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15263METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015264METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015265METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015266RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015267REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015268TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015269WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15270---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015271
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152738. Logging
15274----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015275
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015276One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15277provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15278very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15279provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15280state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015281to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015282headers.
15283
15284In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15285about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15286send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15287
15288 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15289 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15290 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15291 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15292 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015293 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15294 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015295
15296The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15297allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15298as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15299while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15300real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15301delay.
15302
15303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153048.1. Log levels
15305---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015306
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015307TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015308source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015309HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15310in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15311track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15312syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15313about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015314
15315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153168.2. Log formats
15317----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015318
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015319HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015320and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15321slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15322options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015323
15324 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15325 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15326 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15327 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15328 extents.
15329
15330 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15331 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15332 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15333 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15334 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15335
15336 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15337 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15338 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15339 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15340 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15341
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015342 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15343 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15344 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15345 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15346
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015347 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15348
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015349Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15350specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15351field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15352servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15353always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15354identifier.
15355
15356Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15357 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15358 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15359 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15360 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15361
15362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153638.2.1. Default log format
15364-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015365
15366This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15367as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15368format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15369
15370 Example :
15371 listen www
15372 mode http
15373 log global
15374 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15375
15376 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15377 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15378 (www/HTTP)
15379
15380 Field Format Extract from the example above
15381 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15382 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15383 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15384 4 'to' to
15385 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15386 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15387
15388Detailed fields description :
15389 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15390 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15391 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15392 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15393 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15394 and processed the connection.
15395 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15396
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015397In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15398"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15399connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15400
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015401It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15402will eventually disappear.
15403
15404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154058.2.2. TCP log format
15406---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015407
15408The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15409is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15410information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15411counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15412emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15413environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15414the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15415sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015416specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15417not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15418fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15419marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015420
15421 Example :
15422 frontend fnt
15423 mode tcp
15424 option tcplog
15425 log global
15426 default_backend bck
15427
15428 backend bck
15429 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15430
15431 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15432 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15433 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15434
15435 Field Format Extract from the example above
15436 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15437 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15438 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15439 4 frontend_name fnt
15440 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15441 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15442 7 bytes_read* 212
15443 8 termination_state --
15444 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15445 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15446
15447Detailed fields description :
15448 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015449 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15450 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15451 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015452 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15453 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15454 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015455
15456 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015457 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15458 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15459 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015460
15461 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15462 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15463 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15464 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15465
15466 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15467 and processed the connection.
15468
15469 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15470 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15471 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15472 applications.
15473
15474 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15475 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15476 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15477 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15478 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15479
15480 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15481 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15482 See "Timers" below for more details.
15483
15484 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15485 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15486 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15487 "Timers" below for more details.
15488
15489 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015490 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015491 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15492 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15493 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15494 details.
15495
15496 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15497 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15498 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15499 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15500 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15501
15502 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15503 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15504 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15505 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15506 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15507 for more details.
15508
15509 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015510 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015511 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15512 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15513 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015514 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015515
15516 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15517 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15518 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15519 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15520 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15521 caused by a denial of service attack.
15522
15523 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15524 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15525 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15526 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15527 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15528 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15529 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15530 denial of service attack.
15531
15532 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15533 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15534 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15535 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15536 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15537 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15538 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15539 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15540 be processed than on other servers.
15541
15542 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15543 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15544 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15545 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15546 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15547 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15548 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15549 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15550 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15551 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15552 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15553 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15554 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15555
15556 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15557 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15558 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15559 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15560 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15561 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15562 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15563 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15564
15565 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15566 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15567 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15568 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15569 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15570 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15571 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15572 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15573 occurs.
15574
15575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155768.2.3. HTTP log format
15577----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015578
15579The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15580is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15581the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15582are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15583emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15584generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15585"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15586which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015587frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15588is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015589
15590Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15591slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15592with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15593
15594 Example :
15595 frontend http-in
15596 mode http
15597 option httplog
15598 log global
15599 default_backend bck
15600
15601 backend static
15602 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15603
15604 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15605 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15606 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015607 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015608
15609 Field Format Extract from the example above
15610 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15611 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015612 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015613 4 frontend_name http-in
15614 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015615 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015616 7 status_code 200
15617 8 bytes_read* 2750
15618 9 captured_request_cookie -
15619 10 captured_response_cookie -
15620 11 termination_state ----
15621 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15622 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15623 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15624 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15625 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015626
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015627Detailed fields description :
15628 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015629 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15630 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15631 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015632 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15633 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15634 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015635
15636 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015637 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15638 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15639 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015640
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015641 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15642 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015643
15644 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15645 and processed the connection.
15646
15647 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15648 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15649 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15650
15651 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15652 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15653 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15654 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15655 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15656 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15657
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015658 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15659 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15660 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15661 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15662 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15663 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15664 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015665
15666 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15667 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15668 See "Timers" below for more details.
15669
15670 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15671 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15672 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15673 below for more details.
15674
15675 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15676 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15677 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15678 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15679 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15680 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15681 for more details.
15682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015683 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15684 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15685 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15686 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15687 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15688 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15689 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15690 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015691
15692 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15693 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15694 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15695
15696 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15697 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15698 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15699 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15700 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15701 overflowing.
15702
15703 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15704 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15705 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15706 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15707 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15708 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15709 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15710 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15711
15712 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15713 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15714 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15715 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15716 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15717 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15718 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15719 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15720
15721 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15722 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15723 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15724 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15725 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15726 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15727 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15728
15729 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015730 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015731 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15732 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15733 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015734 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015735 system.
15736
15737 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15738 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15739 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15740 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15741 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15742 caused by a denial of service attack.
15743
15744 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15745 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15746 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15747 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15748 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15749 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15750 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15751 denial of service attack.
15752
15753 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15754 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15755 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15756 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15757 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15758 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15759 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15760 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15761 processed than on other servers.
15762
15763 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15764 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15765 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15766 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15767 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15768 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15769 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15770 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15771 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15772 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15773 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15774 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15775 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15776
15777 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15778 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15779 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15780 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15781 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15782 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15783 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15784 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15785
15786 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15787 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15788 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15789 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15790 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15791 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15792 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15793 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15794 occurs.
15795
15796 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15797 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15798 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15799 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15800 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15801 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15802 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15803 cookies" below for more details.
15804
15805 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15806 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15807 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15808 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15809 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15810 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15811 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15812 and cookies" below for more details.
15813
15814 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15815 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15816 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15817 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15818 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15819 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15820 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15821 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15822
15823
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200158248.2.4. Custom log format
15825------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015826
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015827The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015828mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015829
15830HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15831Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15832separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15833prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15834
15835Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15836variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015837("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015838
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015839If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015840as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015841less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15842the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15843
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015844Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015845In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015846in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015847
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015848Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15849'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15850https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15851such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15852
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015853Flags are :
15854 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015855 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015856 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15857 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015858
15859 Example:
15860
15861 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15862 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15863
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015864 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15865
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015866At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15867
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015868 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15869 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015870
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015871the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015873 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15874 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15875 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015876
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015877and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15878
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015879 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15880 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015881
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015882Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15883
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015884 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015885 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015886 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15887 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15888 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015889 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15890 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15891 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015892 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015893 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15894 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015895 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015896 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15897 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015898 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015899 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015900 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015901 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015902 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015903 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015904 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015905 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15906 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15907 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15908 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15909 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015910 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015911 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15912 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015913 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015914 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15915 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015916 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15917 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15918 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015919 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015920 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15921 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015922 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015923 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15924 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15925 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015926 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015927 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015928 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15929 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15930 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15931 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015932 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015933 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015934 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015935 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015936 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015937 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015938 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15939 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15940 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015941 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015942 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15943 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015944 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015945 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15946 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15947 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015948 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015949 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015950 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015951
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015952 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015953
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015954
159558.2.5. Error log format
15956-----------------------
15957
15958When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15959protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15960By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15961"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15962will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15963logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15964
15965The format looks like this :
15966
15967 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15968 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15969 Connection error during SSL handshake
15970
15971 Field Format Extract from the example above
15972 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15973 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15974 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15975 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15976 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15977
15978These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15979failures.
15980
15981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159828.3. Advanced logging options
15983-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015984
15985Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15986just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15987options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15988for more information about their usage.
15989
15990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159918.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15992------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015993
15994It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15995haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15996commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15997monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15998ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15999
16000 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16001 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16002 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16003 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16004
16005 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16006 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16007 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016008 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016009 such as other load-balancers.
16010
16011 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16012 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16013 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16014
16015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160168.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16017----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016018
16019The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16020what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16021or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
16022"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
16023just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16024log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16025after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16026is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16027with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16028with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16029
16030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160318.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16032------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016033
16034Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16035for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16036"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16037retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16038raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16039a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16040file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16041you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16042"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16043
16044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160458.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16046--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016047
16048Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16049multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16050them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16051"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16052logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16053error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16054and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16055too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16056useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16057alternative.
16058
16059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160608.4. Timing events
16061------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016062
16063Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16064reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16065the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16066frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016067mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16068addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16069
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016070Timings events in HTTP mode:
16071
16072 first request 2nd request
16073 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16074 t tr t tr ...
16075 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16076 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16077 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16078 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16079 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16080
16081Timings events in TCP mode:
16082
16083 TCP session
16084 |<----------------->|
16085 t t
16086 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16087 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16088 |<------ Tt ------->|
16089
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016090 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16091 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16092 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16093 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16094 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16095 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16096 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016098 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16099 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16100 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16101 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16102 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16103 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16104 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16105 nothing was received on the connection.
16106
16107 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16108 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16109 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16110 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16111 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16112 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16113 request typed by hand during a test.
16114
16115 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16116 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16117 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16118 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16119 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16120 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16121 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016122
16123 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16124 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16125 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16126 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16127 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16128
16129 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16130 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16131 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16132 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16133 connection never established.
16134
16135 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16136 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16137 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16138 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16139 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16140 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16141 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16142 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16143 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16144 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16145 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16146
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016147 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16148 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16149 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16150 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16151 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16152 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16153
16154 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16155
16156 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16157 "Ta" can never be negative.
16158
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016159 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16160 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016161 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16162 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016163 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016165 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016166
16167 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016168 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16169 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016170
16171These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16172protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16173that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016174due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16175"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16176that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016177
16178Most common cases :
16179
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016180 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16181 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16182 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16183 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16184 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16185 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16186 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16187 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16188 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16189 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16190 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016191 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016192
16193 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16194 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16195 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16196 of ms on remote networks.
16197
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016198 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16199 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16200 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016202 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16203 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16204 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16205 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16206 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16207 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16208 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16209 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16210 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016211
16212Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16213
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016214 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016215 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016216 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016217
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016218 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016219 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16220 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16221
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016222 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016223 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16224 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16225 flags.
16226
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016227 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16228 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016229 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16230 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16231 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16232 the client connection was maintained open.
16233
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016234 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016235 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016236 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016237 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16238
16239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162408.5. Session state at disconnection
16241-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016242
16243TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16244"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
162452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16246each of which has a special meaning :
16247
16248 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16249 session to terminate :
16250
16251 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16252
16253 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16254 server explicitly refused it.
16255
16256 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16257 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16258 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16259 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016260 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16261
16262 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16263 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016264
16265 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16266 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16267 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16268 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16269 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16270
16271 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16272 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16273 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16274 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16275 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16276
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016277 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16278 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16279
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016280 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16281 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16282 backup connections when going up.
16283
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016284 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016286 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16287 send or receive data.
16288
16289 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16290 send or receive data.
16291
16292 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16293 with nothing left in the buffers.
16294
16295 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16296
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016297 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016298 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16299
16300 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16301 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16302 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16303 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16304 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16305
16306 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16307 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16308
16309 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16310 server (HTTP only).
16311
16312 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16313
16314 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16315 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16316 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16317
16318 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16319 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16320 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16321
16322 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16323
16324 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16325 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16326
16327 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16328 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16329 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16330
16331 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16332 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016333 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16334 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016335
16336 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16337 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16338 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16339 another server.
16340
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016341 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016342 server.
16343
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016344 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16345 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16346 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16347 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16348
16349 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16350 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16351 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16352 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16353
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016354 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16355 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16356 "use-server" rule).
16357
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016358 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16359
16360 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16361 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16362
16363 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16364
16365 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16366 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16367 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16368
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016369 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16370 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016371 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016372 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16373 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016375 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16376
16377 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16378 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16379
16380 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16381
16382 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16383
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016384The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16385was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016386helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16387starvation, attacks, etc...
16388
16389The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16390alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16391easier finding and understanding.
16392
16393 Flags Reason
16394
16395 -- Normal termination.
16396
16397 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16398 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16399 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16400 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16401
16402 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16403 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16404 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16405 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16406 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16407 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016409 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16410 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016411 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016412
16413 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16414 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16415 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16416
16417 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16418 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16419 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16420 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16421 the server takes too long to respond.
16422
16423 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16424 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16425 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16426 long a time to respond.
16427
16428 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16429 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16430 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16431 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016432 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16433 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016434
16435 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16436 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16437 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16438 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16439 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016440 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016441 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16442 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16443 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16444 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16445 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16446 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16447 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16448 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16449 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16450 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16451 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16452 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016453
16454 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16455 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016456 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16457 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16458 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16459 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016460
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016461 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16462 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016464 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016465 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16466 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16467 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16468 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16469 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16470
16471 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16472 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16473 503 or 504 here.
16474
16475 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16476 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16477 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16478 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16479 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16480
16481 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16482 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016483 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016484 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16485 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16486
16487 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16488 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16489 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16490 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16491 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16492 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16493 between haproxy and the server.
16494
16495 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16496 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16497 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16498 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16499 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16500 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16501 solution is to fix the application.
16502
16503 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16504 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16505 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16506 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16507 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16508 external attacks.
16509
16510 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16511 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016512 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016513 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16514 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16515
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016516 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16517 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16518 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016519 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16520 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016521
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016522 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16523 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16524 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16525 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016526 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16527 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16528 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16529 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16530 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016531
16532 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16533 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16534 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16535 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16536
16537 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16538 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16539 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16540 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16541
16542 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16543 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16544 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16545 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16546
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016547The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16548persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16549important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16550re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16551
16552 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16553
16554 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16555 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16556 set on a GET request.
16557
16558 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16559 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016560 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016561 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16562
16563 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16564 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16565 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16566
16567 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16568 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16569 already got a cookie.
16570
16571 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16572 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16573 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16574 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16575 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16576
16577 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16578 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16579 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16580
16581 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16582 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16583 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16584
16585 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16586 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16587
16588 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16589 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16590 then advertised in the response.
16591
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165938.6. Non-printable characters
16594-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016595
16596In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16597consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16598converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16599prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16600being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16601escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16602is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16603'}' when logging headers.
16604
16605Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16606issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16607containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16608
16609Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16610the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16611performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16612
16613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16615---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616
16617Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16618achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016619section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016620cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16621the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16622the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016623locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16625user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16626a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16627wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16628
16629 Examples :
16630 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16631 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16632
16633 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16634 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16635
16636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166378.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16638---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639
16640Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16641proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16642the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16643server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16644
16645Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16646response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016647section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016648
16649It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016650time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16651appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016652are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16653and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16654follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16655request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16656in the logs.
16657
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016658As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16659frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16660an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16661
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662 Example :
16663 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16664 listen proxy-out
16665 mode http
16666 option httplog
16667 option logasap
16668 log global
16669 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16670
16671 # log the name of the virtual server
16672 capture request header Host len 20
16673
16674 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16675 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16676
16677 # log the beginning of the referrer
16678 capture request header Referer len 20
16679
16680 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16681 capture response header Server len 20
16682
16683 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16684 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16685
16686 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16687 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16688
16689 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16690 capture response header Via len 20
16691
16692 # log the URL location during a redirection
16693 capture response header Location len 20
16694
16695 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16696 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16697 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16698 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16699 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16700
16701 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16702 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16703 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16704 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016705 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016706
16707 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16708 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16709 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16710 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16711 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016712 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
16714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167158.9. Examples of logs
16716---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016717
16718These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16719them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16720reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16721
16722 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16723 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16724 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16725
16726 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16727 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16728
16729 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16730 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16731 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16732
16733 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16734 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16735
16736 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16737 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16738 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16739
16740 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016741 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016742 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16743 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16744
16745 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16746 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16747 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16748
16749 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16750 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016751 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016752 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16753 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16754 to return the 502 and not the server.
16755
16756 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016757 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016758
16759 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16760 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16761 Nothing was sent to any server.
16762
16763 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16764 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16765
16766 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16767 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16768 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16769 send a 408 return code to the client.
16770
16771 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16772 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16773
16774 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16775 5 seconds ("c----").
16776
16777 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16778 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016779 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016780
16781 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016782 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016783 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16784 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16785 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16786 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16787 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016788
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016789
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167909. Supported filters
16791--------------------
16792
16793Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16794accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16795unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16796
16797See also : "filter"
16798
167999.1. Trace
16800----------
16801
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016802filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016803
16804 Arguments:
16805 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16806 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16807
16808 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16809 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16810 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16811 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16812
16813 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16814 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16815 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16816 amount of the parsed data.
16817
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016818 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16819
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016820This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16821callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16822information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16823filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16824
16825Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16826tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16827a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16828
16829
168309.2. HTTP compression
16831---------------------
16832
16833filter compression
16834
16835The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16836keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16837when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16838use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16839used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16840filters evaluation order.
16841
16842See also : "compression"
16843
16844
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200168459.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16846--------------------------------------------
16847
16848filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16849
16850 Arguments :
16851
16852 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16853 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16854 parsed.
16855
16856 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16857 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16858 part must be placed in its own scope.
16859
16860The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16861external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16862streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16863exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16864also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16865
16866SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16867the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16868
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016869For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016870"doc/SPOE.txt".
16871
16872Important note:
16873 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16874 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016876/*
16877 * Local variables:
16878 * fill-column: 79
16879 * End:
16880 */